PostgreSQL Source Code git master
Loading...
Searching...
No Matches
xlog.c
Go to the documentation of this file.
1/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
2 *
3 * xlog.c
4 * PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
5 *
6 * The Write-Ahead Log (WAL) functionality is split into several source
7 * files, in addition to this one:
8 *
9 * xloginsert.c - Functions for constructing WAL records
10 * xlogrecovery.c - WAL recovery and standby code
11 * xlogreader.c - Facility for reading WAL files and parsing WAL records
12 * xlogutils.c - Helper functions for WAL redo routines
13 *
14 * This file contains functions for coordinating database startup and
15 * checkpointing, and managing the write-ahead log buffers when the
16 * system is running.
17 *
18 * StartupXLOG() is the main entry point of the startup process. It
19 * coordinates database startup, performing WAL recovery, and the
20 * transition from WAL recovery into normal operations.
21 *
22 * XLogInsertRecord() inserts a WAL record into the WAL buffers. Most
23 * callers should not call this directly, but use the functions in
24 * xloginsert.c to construct the WAL record. XLogFlush() can be used
25 * to force the WAL to disk.
26 *
27 * In addition to those, there are many other functions for interrogating
28 * the current system state, and for starting/stopping backups.
29 *
30 *
31 * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
32 * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
33 *
34 * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
35 *
36 *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
37 */
38
39#include "postgres.h"
40
41#include <ctype.h>
42#include <math.h>
43#include <time.h>
44#include <fcntl.h>
45#include <sys/stat.h>
46#include <sys/time.h>
47#include <unistd.h>
48
49#include "access/clog.h"
50#include "access/commit_ts.h"
51#include "access/heaptoast.h"
52#include "access/multixact.h"
53#include "access/rewriteheap.h"
54#include "access/subtrans.h"
55#include "access/timeline.h"
56#include "access/transam.h"
57#include "access/twophase.h"
58#include "access/xact.h"
60#include "access/xlogarchive.h"
61#include "access/xloginsert.h"
62#include "access/xlogreader.h"
63#include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
64#include "access/xlogutils.h"
65#include "access/xlogwait.h"
66#include "backup/basebackup.h"
67#include "catalog/catversion.h"
68#include "catalog/pg_control.h"
69#include "catalog/pg_database.h"
71#include "common/file_utils.h"
72#include "executor/instrument.h"
73#include "miscadmin.h"
74#include "pg_trace.h"
75#include "pgstat.h"
76#include "port/atomics.h"
77#include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
78#include "postmaster/startup.h"
81#include "replication/origin.h"
82#include "replication/slot.h"
87#include "storage/bufmgr.h"
88#include "storage/fd.h"
89#include "storage/ipc.h"
91#include "storage/latch.h"
92#include "storage/predicate.h"
93#include "storage/proc.h"
94#include "storage/procarray.h"
95#include "storage/reinit.h"
96#include "storage/spin.h"
97#include "storage/sync.h"
98#include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
99#include "utils/guc_tables.h"
102#include "utils/ps_status.h"
103#include "utils/relmapper.h"
104#include "utils/snapmgr.h"
105#include "utils/timeout.h"
106#include "utils/timestamp.h"
107#include "utils/varlena.h"
108#include "utils/wait_event.h"
109
110#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
111#include "utils/memutils.h"
112#endif
113
114/* timeline ID to be used when bootstrapping */
115#define BootstrapTimeLineID 1
116
117/* User-settable parameters */
118int max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
119int min_wal_size_mb = 80; /* 80 MB */
121int XLOGbuffers = -1;
125bool EnableHotStandby = false;
126bool fullPageWrites = true;
127bool wal_log_hints = false;
131bool wal_init_zero = true;
132bool wal_recycle = true;
133bool log_checkpoints = true;
136int CommitDelay = 0; /* precommit delay in microseconds */
137int CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
140int wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024;
142
143#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
144bool XLOG_DEBUG = false;
145#endif
146
148
149/*
150 * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
151 * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
152 * which needs to iterate all the locks.
153 */
154#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS 8
155
156/*
157 * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
158 * checkpoint.
159 */
161
162/* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
164static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
165
166/*
167 * Track whether there were any deferred checks for custom resource managers
168 * specified in wal_consistency_checking.
169 */
171
172/*
173 * GUC support
174 */
176 {"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
177#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
178 {"fsync_writethrough", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
179#endif
180 {"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
181#ifdef O_SYNC
182 {"open_sync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
183#endif
184#ifdef O_DSYNC
185 {"open_datasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
186#endif
187 {NULL, 0, false}
188};
189
190
191/*
192 * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
193 * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
194 */
196 {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
197 {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
198 {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
199 {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
200 {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
201 {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
202 {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
203 {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
204 {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
205 {NULL, 0, false}
206};
207
208/*
209 * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
210 * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
211 * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
212 */
214
215/*
216 * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
217 * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
218 * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
219 * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
220 */
222
223/*
224 * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
225 * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE. True actually
226 * means "not known, need to check the shared state".
227 */
228static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
229
230/*
231 * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
232 * 1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
233 * 0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
234 * -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
235 * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
236 * is not in progress. But we can also force the value for special cases.
237 * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
238 * being numerically the same as bool true and false.
239 */
241
242/*
243 * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
244 * current backend. It is updated for all inserts. XactLastRecEnd points to
245 * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
246 * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
247 * created any XLOG records.
248 *
249 * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date. When committing,
250 * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
251 * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
252 * the transaction. But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
253 * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
254 * stored here. The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
255 * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
256 */
260
261/*
262 * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
263 * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
264 * CHECKPOINT record). We update this from the shared-memory copy,
265 * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
266 * hold an insertion lock). See XLogInsertRecord for details. We are also
267 * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
268 * see GetRedoRecPtr.
269 *
270 * NB: Code that uses this variable must be prepared not only for the
271 * possibility that it may be arbitrarily out of date, but also for the
272 * possibility that it might be set to InvalidXLogRecPtr. We used to
273 * initialize it as a side effect of the first call to RecoveryInProgress(),
274 * which meant that most code that might use it could assume that it had a
275 * real if perhaps stale value. That's no longer the case.
276 */
278
279/*
280 * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (fullPageWrites ||
281 * runningBackups > 0). It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
282 * a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
283 *
284 * NB: Initially this is false, and there's no guarantee that it will be
285 * initialized to any other value before it is first used. Any code that
286 * makes use of it must recheck the value after obtaining a WALInsertLock,
287 * and respond appropriately if it turns out that the previous value wasn't
288 * accurate.
289 */
290static bool doPageWrites;
291
292/*----------
293 * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
294 *
295 * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
296 * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
297 * The positions already written/fsynced are maintained in logWriteResult
298 * and logFlushResult using atomic access.
299 * In addition to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of
300 * both in LogwrtResult, which is updated when convenient.
301 *
302 * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
303 * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
304 *
305 * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
306 * so it's a plain spinlock. The other locks are held longer (potentially
307 * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them. These locks are:
308 *
309 * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
310 * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping. If the
311 * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
312 * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
313 *
314 * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
315 * XLogFlush).
316 *
317 * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
318 * new log file.
319 *
320 *----------
321 */
322
323typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
324{
325 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 to write out */
326 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 to flush */
328
329typedef struct XLogwrtResult
330{
331 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 written out */
332 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
334
335/*
336 * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
337 * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
338 * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
339 * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
340 * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
341 *
342 * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
343 * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
344 * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
345 * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
346 * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
347 * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
348 * you're about to write out.
349 *
350 * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
351 * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
352 * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
353 * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
354 * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
355 * insertion.
356 *
357 * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
358 * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
359 * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
360 * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
361 *
362 * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
363 * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
364 * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
365 * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
366 * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
367 * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
368 * records. Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
369 * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
370 */
377
378/*
379 * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
380 * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
381 * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
382 * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
383 * array start address is suitably aligned.)
384 */
390
391/*
392 * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
393 * functions to start and stop backups.
394 */
396
397/*
398 * Shared state data for WAL insertion.
399 */
400typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
401{
402 slock_t insertpos_lck; /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
403
404 /*
405 * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
406 * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
407 * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
408 * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
409 * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
410 */
413
414 /*
415 * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
416 * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
417 * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
418 * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
419 * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
420 */
422
423 /*
424 * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
425 * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
426 * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
427 * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
428 * actually affects WAL-logging by backends. Checkpointer sets at startup
429 * or after SIGHUP.
430 *
431 * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
432 * you must hold ALL the locks.
433 */
434 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* current redo point for insertions */
436
437 /*
438 * runningBackups is a counter indicating the number of backups currently
439 * in progress. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location
440 * used as a starting point for an online backup.
441 */
444
445 /*
446 * WAL insertion locks.
447 */
450
451/*
452 * Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
453 */
454typedef struct XLogCtlData
455{
457
458 /* Protected by info_lck: */
460 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
461 XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN; /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
462 XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN; /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
463
464 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
465
466 /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. */
468
469 /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
472
473 /* These are accessed using atomics -- info_lck not needed */
474 pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult; /* last byte + 1 inserted to buffers */
475 pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult; /* last byte + 1 written out */
476 pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
477
478 /*
479 * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
480 *
481 * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
482 * hold WALBufMappingLock. To change the identity of a buffer that's
483 * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
484 * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
485 * in-progress insertions to the page by calling
486 * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
487 */
489
490 /*
491 * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
492 * and xlblocks values certainly do. xlblocks values are protected by
493 * WALBufMappingLock.
494 */
495 char *pages; /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
496 pg_atomic_uint64 *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
497 int XLogCacheBlck; /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
498
499 /*
500 * InsertTimeLineID is the timeline into which new WAL is being inserted
501 * and flushed. It is zero during recovery, and does not change once set.
502 *
503 * If we create a new timeline when the system was started up,
504 * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
505 * Otherwise it's equal to InsertTimeLineID.
506 *
507 * We set these fields while holding info_lck. Most that reads these
508 * values knows that recovery is no longer in progress and so can safely
509 * read the value without a lock, but code that could be run either during
510 * or after recovery can take info_lck while reading these values.
511 */
514
515 /*
516 * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
517 * recovery. Protected by info_lck.
518 */
520
521 /*
522 * InstallXLogFileSegmentActive indicates whether the checkpointer should
523 * arrange for future segments by recycling and/or PreallocXlogFiles().
524 * Protected by ControlFileLock. Only the startup process changes it. If
525 * true, anyone can use InstallXLogFileSegment(). If false, the startup
526 * process owns the exclusive right to install segments, by reading from
527 * the archive and possibly replacing existing files.
528 */
530
531 /*
532 * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
533 * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
534 * Protected by info_lck.
535 */
537
538 /*
539 * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
540 * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
541 * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record. Used by the
542 * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
543 *
544 * Protected by info_lck.
545 */
549
550 /*
551 * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
552 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
553 */
555
556 slock_t info_lck; /* locks shared variables shown above */
558
559/*
560 * Classification of XLogInsertRecord operations.
561 */
568
570
571/* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
573
574/*
575 * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
576 */
578
579/*
580 * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
581 * multiple evaluation!
582 */
583#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr) \
584 (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
585
586/* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
587#define NextBufIdx(idx) \
588 (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
589
590/*
591 * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
592 * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
593 */
594#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr) \
595 (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
596
597/*
598 * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
599 */
600#define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
601
602/*
603 * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
604 * Rounds down.
605 */
606#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize) XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
607
608/* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
610
611/*
612 * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
613 * See discussion above.
614 */
616
617/*
618 * Update local copy of shared XLogCtl->log{Write,Flush}Result
619 *
620 * It's critical that Flush always trails Write, so the order of the reads is
621 * important, as is the barrier. See also XLogWrite.
622 */
623#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target) \
624 do { \
625 _target.Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult); \
626 pg_read_barrier(); \
627 _target.Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult); \
628 } while (0)
629
630/*
631 * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
632 * openLogSegNo identifies the segment, and openLogTLI the corresponding TLI.
633 * These variables are only used to write the XLOG, and so will normally refer
634 * to the active segment.
635 *
636 * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
637 */
638static int openLogFile = -1;
641
642/*
643 * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file. When running
644 * crash recovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
645 * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
646 * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
647 * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
648 */
651static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
652
653/* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
654static int MyLockNo = 0;
655static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
656
657#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
659#endif
660
664static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
665static void XLogReportParameters(void);
666static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
667static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
671static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
673
675 bool opportunistic);
676static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible);
677static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
679 TimeLineID tli);
680static void XLogFileClose(void);
681static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli);
682static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
685static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
688static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
689static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
690static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
691static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
692static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void);
693static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version);
694static void WriteControlFile(void);
695static void ReadControlFile(void);
696static void UpdateControlFile(void);
697static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize);
698
699static int get_sync_bit(int method);
700
701static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
704 TimeLineID tli);
705static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
710static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli);
714
715static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
716static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
717static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
718static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
719
720/*
721 * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
722 * chunks. This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
723 * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
724 *
725 * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
726 * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
727 * images. If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
728 * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr. The caller can then recalculate
729 * which pages need a full-page image, and retry. If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
730 * record is always inserted.
731 *
732 * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
733 * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
734 *
735 * 'topxid_included' tells whether the top-transaction id is logged along with
736 * current subtransaction. See XLogRecordAssemble().
737 *
738 * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
739 * data must be MAXALIGNed. XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
740 * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
741 * by the caller.
742 *
743 * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
744 * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
745 * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
746 * before the data page can be written out. This implements the basic
747 * WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
748 */
752 uint8 flags,
753 int num_fpi,
755 bool topxid_included)
756{
759 bool inserted;
760 XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
761 uint8 info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
767
768 /* Does this record type require special handling? */
769 if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
770 {
771 if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
773 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
775 }
776
777 /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
779
780 /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
781 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
782 elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
783
784 /*
785 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
786 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
787 */
789
790 /*----------
791 *
792 * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
793 * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
794 * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
795 *
796 * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
797 * reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
798 * insertpos_lck.
799 *
800 * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
801 * correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
802 * record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
803 *
804 * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
805 * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
806 * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
807 * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
808 * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
809 * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
810 * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
811 *
812 * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
813 * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
814 *
815 * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
816 * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
817 * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
818 * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
819 *
820 *----------
821 */
823
824 if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
825 {
827
828 /*
829 * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
830 * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
831 * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
832 * this case and fast otherwise.
833 *
834 * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
835 * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
836 * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
837 *
838 * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
839 * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
840 * our local copy but not force a recomputation. (If doPageWrites was
841 * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
842 * but we choose not to bother.)
843 */
844 if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
845 {
847 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
848 }
849 doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
850
851 if (doPageWrites &&
854 {
855 /*
856 * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
857 * didn't back up. Start over.
858 */
861 return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
862 }
863
864 /*
865 * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
866 * pointer.
867 */
869 &rechdr->xl_prev);
870
871 /* Normal records are always inserted. */
872 inserted = true;
873 }
874 else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
875 {
876 /*
877 * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
878 * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
879 * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
880 * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
881 *
882 * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
883 * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
884 * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
885 * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
886 */
890 }
891 else
892 {
894
895 /*
896 * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
897 * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
898 * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
899 * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
900 * update it afterwards.
901 */
905 &rechdr->xl_prev);
906 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
907 inserted = true;
908 }
909
910 if (inserted)
911 {
912 /*
913 * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
914 * header.
915 */
916 rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
919 rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
920
921 /*
922 * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
923 * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
924 */
925 CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len,
928
929 /*
930 * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
931 * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
932 * update the first one.
933 */
934 if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
935 {
936 int lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
937
939 }
940 }
941 else
942 {
943 /*
944 * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
945 * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
946 * to do anything.
947 */
948 }
949
950 /*
951 * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
952 */
954
956
958
959 /*
960 * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
961 * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
962 */
963 if (topxid_included)
965
966 /*
967 * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
968 */
970 {
972 /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
977 }
978
979 /*
980 * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
981 * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
982 * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
983 */
984 if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
985 {
988
989 /*
990 * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
991 * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
992 * xlog-switch record.
993 */
994 if (inserted)
995 {
998 {
1000
1001 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
1003 else
1005 }
1006 }
1007 }
1008
1009#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
1010 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
1011 {
1013 XLogRecord *record;
1017 char *errormsg = NULL;
1019
1021
1023 appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%08X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
1024
1025 /*
1026 * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
1027 * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
1028 * contiguous chunk.
1029 */
1031 for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
1033
1034 /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
1035 record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
1038
1039 if (!debug_reader)
1041 XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
1042 .segment_open = NULL,
1043 .segment_close = NULL),
1044 NULL);
1045 if (!debug_reader)
1046 {
1047 appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
1048 }
1050 decoded,
1051 record,
1052 EndPos,
1053 &errormsg))
1054 {
1055 appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
1056 errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
1057 }
1058 else
1059 {
1060 appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
1061
1062 debug_reader->record = decoded;
1064 debug_reader->record = NULL;
1065 }
1066 elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
1067
1068 pfree(decoded);
1069 pfree(buf.data);
1070 pfree(recordBuf.data);
1072 }
1073#endif
1074
1075 /*
1076 * Update our global variables
1077 */
1080
1081 /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
1082 if (inserted)
1083 {
1084 pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
1088
1089 /* Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data */
1090 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
1091 }
1092
1093 return EndPos;
1094}
1095
1096/*
1097 * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
1098 * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
1099 * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
1100 * used to set the xl_prev of this record.
1101 *
1102 * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
1103 * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
1104 * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
1105 * busy system.
1106 *
1107 * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
1108 * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
1109 *
1110 * NB: Testing shows that XLogInsertRecord runs faster if this code is inlined;
1111 * however, because there are two call sites, the compiler is reluctant to
1112 * inline. We use pg_attribute_always_inline here to try to convince it.
1113 */
1117{
1122
1123 size = MAXALIGN(size);
1124
1125 /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
1126 Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
1127
1128 /*
1129 * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
1130 * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
1131 * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
1132 * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
1133 * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
1134 * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
1135 * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
1136 * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
1137 */
1138 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1139
1140 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1141 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1142 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1143 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1144 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1145
1146 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1147
1151
1152 /*
1153 * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
1154 * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
1155 */
1159}
1160
1161/*
1162 * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
1163 *
1164 * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
1165 * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
1166 * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
1167 * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
1168 * reserving any space, and the function returns false.
1169*/
1170static bool
1172{
1178 XLogRecPtr ptr;
1180
1181 /*
1182 * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
1183 * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
1184 * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
1185 * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
1186 */
1187 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1188
1189 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1190
1192 if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
1193 {
1194 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1195 *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
1196 return false;
1197 }
1198
1199 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1200 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1201
1204
1207 {
1208 /* consume the rest of the segment */
1209 *EndPos += segleft;
1211 }
1212 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1213 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1214
1215 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1216
1218
1223
1224 return true;
1225}
1226
1227/*
1228 * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord. Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
1229 * area in the WAL.
1230 */
1231static void
1234{
1235 char *currpos;
1236 int freespace;
1237 int written;
1240
1241 /*
1242 * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
1243 * inserting to.
1244 */
1245 CurrPos = StartPos;
1246 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1247 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1248
1249 /*
1250 * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
1251 * on this page.
1252 */
1253 Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
1254
1255 /* Copy record data */
1256 written = 0;
1257 while (rdata != NULL)
1258 {
1259 const char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
1260 int rdata_len = rdata->len;
1261
1262 while (rdata_len > freespace)
1263 {
1264 /*
1265 * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
1266 */
1267 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
1268 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
1269 rdata_data += freespace;
1270 rdata_len -= freespace;
1271 written += freespace;
1272 CurrPos += freespace;
1273
1274 /*
1275 * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
1276 * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
1277 *
1278 * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
1279 * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
1280 * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
1281 * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
1282 */
1283 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1284 pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
1285 pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
1286 pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
1287
1288 /* skip over the page header */
1290 {
1292 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1293 }
1294 else
1295 {
1297 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1298 }
1299 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1300 }
1301
1302 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
1303 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
1304 currpos += rdata_len;
1305 CurrPos += rdata_len;
1306 freespace -= rdata_len;
1307 written += rdata_len;
1308
1309 rdata = rdata->next;
1310 }
1312
1313 /*
1314 * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
1315 * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment. We
1316 * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
1317 */
1319 {
1320 /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
1322
1323 /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
1325
1326 /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
1327 CurrPos += freespace;
1328
1329 /*
1330 * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
1331 * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
1332 * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
1333 * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
1334 */
1335 while (CurrPos < EndPos)
1336 {
1337 /*
1338 * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
1339 * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
1340 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...). The page would be left initialized
1341 * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
1342 * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
1343 *
1344 * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
1345 * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
1346 * differ from page to page) are not. The effect varies with
1347 * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
1348 * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
1349 *
1350 * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
1351 * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
1352 * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
1353 * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
1354 * and zero most of the page. Then we just zero the page header.
1355 */
1356 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1357 MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1358
1360 }
1361 }
1362 else
1363 {
1364 /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
1366 }
1367
1368 if (CurrPos != EndPos)
1369 ereport(PANIC,
1371 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
1372}
1373
1374/*
1375 * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
1376 */
1377static void
1379{
1380 bool immed;
1381
1382 /*
1383 * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
1384 * the one we used last time. If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
1385 * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
1386 * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
1387 * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
1388 *
1389 * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
1390 * (semi-)randomly. This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
1391 * lot of very short connections.
1392 */
1393 static int lockToTry = -1;
1394
1395 if (lockToTry == -1)
1398
1399 /*
1400 * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
1401 * insert location yet.
1402 */
1404 if (!immed)
1405 {
1406 /*
1407 * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
1408 * time. On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
1409 * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
1410 * lock that no-one else is using. On a system with more inserters
1411 * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
1412 * across the locks.
1413 */
1415 }
1416}
1417
1418/*
1419 * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
1420 * to WAL.
1421 */
1422static void
1424{
1425 int i;
1426
1427 /*
1428 * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
1429 * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
1430 * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
1431 */
1432 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
1433 {
1438 }
1439 /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
1441
1442 holdingAllLocks = true;
1443}
1444
1445/*
1446 * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
1447 *
1448 * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
1449 * next time the lock is acquired.
1450 */
1451static void
1453{
1454 if (holdingAllLocks)
1455 {
1456 int i;
1457
1458 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1461 0);
1462
1463 holdingAllLocks = false;
1464 }
1465 else
1466 {
1469 0);
1470 }
1471}
1472
1473/*
1474 * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
1475 * inserting up to that point.
1476 */
1477static void
1479{
1480 if (holdingAllLocks)
1481 {
1482 /*
1483 * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
1484 * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
1485 */
1488 insertingAt);
1489 }
1490 else
1493 insertingAt);
1494}
1495
1496/*
1497 * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
1498 *
1499 * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
1500 * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
1501 * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
1502 * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
1503 *
1504 * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
1505 * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
1506 * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
1507 * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
1508 * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
1509 */
1510static XLogRecPtr
1512{
1518 int i;
1519
1520 if (MyProc == NULL)
1521 elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
1522
1523 /*
1524 * Check if there's any work to do. Use a barrier to ensure we get the
1525 * freshest value.
1526 */
1528 if (upto <= inserted)
1529 return inserted;
1530
1531 /* Read the current insert position */
1532 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1533 bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1534 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1536
1537 /*
1538 * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
1539 * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
1540 * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
1541 * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
1542 * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
1543 * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
1544 */
1545 if (upto > reservedUpto)
1546 {
1547 ereport(LOG,
1548 errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1551 }
1552
1553 /*
1554 * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
1555 * than 'upto'.
1556 *
1557 * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
1558 * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
1559 * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
1560 * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
1561 */
1563 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1564 {
1566
1567 do
1568 {
1569 /*
1570 * See if this insertion is in progress. LWLockWaitForVar will
1571 * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
1572 * by a LWLockUpdateVar call. When a lock is initially acquired,
1573 * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
1574 * know where it's inserting yet. We will have to wait for it. If
1575 * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
1576 * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
1577 * calling LWLockUpdateVar. But if it has to sleep, it will
1578 * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
1579 * sleeping.
1580 *
1581 * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
1582 * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called. The lack of
1583 * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
1584 * "unused" that have since become used. This is fine because
1585 * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
1586 * want to wait on anyway. Not taking a lock to acquire the
1587 * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
1588 * insertingAt values. This is also fine, because if we read a
1589 * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
1590 * contains atomic operations.
1591 */
1592 if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
1595 {
1596 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
1598 break;
1599 }
1600
1601 /*
1602 * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
1603 * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
1604 */
1605 } while (insertingat < upto);
1606
1609 }
1610
1611 /*
1612 * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
1613 * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
1614 * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
1615 */
1617 finishedUpto);
1618
1619 return finishedUpto;
1620}
1621
1622/*
1623 * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
1624 * given XLogRecPtr.
1625 *
1626 * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
1627 * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
1628 *
1629 * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
1630 * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
1631 * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
1632 * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
1633 * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
1634 * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
1635 * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
1636 * later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
1637 */
1638static char *
1640{
1641 int idx;
1642 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1643 static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
1644 static char *cachedPos = NULL;
1646
1647 /*
1648 * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
1649 * page as last time.
1650 */
1651 if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
1652 {
1654 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1655 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1656 }
1657
1658 /*
1659 * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
1660 * particular buffer. That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
1661 * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
1662 */
1663 idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
1664
1665 /*
1666 * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
1667 * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
1668 * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
1669 * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
1670 * that doesn't happen.
1671 *
1672 * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
1673 * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
1674 * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
1675 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
1676 * we're looking for.
1677 */
1678 expectedEndPtr = ptr;
1680
1682 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1683 {
1685
1686 /*
1687 * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
1688 * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
1689 *
1690 * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
1691 * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
1692 * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
1693 * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
1694 * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
1695 * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
1696 * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
1697 * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
1698 * the page header.
1699 */
1700 if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
1703 else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
1706 else
1707 initializedUpto = ptr;
1708
1710
1711 AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
1713
1714 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1715 elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%08X",
1716 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
1717 }
1718 else
1719 {
1720 /*
1721 * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
1722 * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
1723 */
1725 }
1726
1727 /*
1728 * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
1729 * offset within the page.
1730 */
1731 cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1733
1735 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1736
1737 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1738}
1739
1740/*
1741 * Read WAL data directly from WAL buffers, if available. Returns the number
1742 * of bytes read successfully.
1743 *
1744 * Fewer than 'count' bytes may be read if some of the requested WAL data has
1745 * already been evicted.
1746 *
1747 * No locks are taken.
1748 *
1749 * Caller should ensure that it reads no further than LogwrtResult.Write
1750 * (which should have been updated by the caller when determining how far to
1751 * read). The 'tli' argument is only used as a convenient safety check so that
1752 * callers do not read from WAL buffers on a historical timeline.
1753 */
1754Size
1756 TimeLineID tli)
1757{
1758 char *pdst = dstbuf;
1759 XLogRecPtr recptr = startptr;
1761 Size nbytes = count;
1762
1764 return 0;
1765
1766 Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(startptr));
1767
1768 /*
1769 * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
1770 * buffers before we try to read it.
1771 */
1773 if (startptr + count > inserted)
1774 ereport(ERROR,
1775 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1776 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
1778
1779 /*
1780 * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
1781 * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
1782 * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
1783 *
1784 * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
1785 * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
1786 * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
1787 * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
1788 * happens between the two verification steps.
1789 *
1790 * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
1791 * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
1792 */
1793 while (nbytes > 0)
1794 {
1795 uint32 offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1798 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1799 const char *page;
1800 const char *psrc;
1802
1803 /*
1804 * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
1805 * correct page is present.
1806 */
1807 expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1808
1809 /*
1810 * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
1811 * the WAL buffers.
1812 */
1814 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1815 break;
1816
1817 /*
1818 * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
1819 * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
1820 * determine how much data to read from this page.
1821 */
1822 page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1823 psrc = page + offset;
1824 npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1825
1826 /*
1827 * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
1828 * reordered.
1829 */
1831
1832 /* data copy */
1834
1835 /*
1836 * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
1837 * reordered.
1838 */
1840
1841 /*
1842 * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
1843 * evicted while we were copying the data.
1844 */
1846 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1847 break;
1848
1849 pdst += npagebytes;
1850 recptr += npagebytes;
1851 nbytes -= npagebytes;
1852 }
1853
1854 Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
1855
1856 return pdst - dstbuf;
1857}
1858
1859/*
1860 * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
1861 * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
1862 * page headers.
1863 */
1864static XLogRecPtr
1866{
1871 XLogRecPtr result;
1872
1875
1877 {
1878 /* fits on first page of segment */
1880 }
1881 else
1882 {
1883 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1886
1889
1891 }
1892
1894
1895 return result;
1896}
1897
1898/*
1899 * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
1900 * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
1901 * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
1902 * when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
1903 */
1904static XLogRecPtr
1906{
1911 XLogRecPtr result;
1912
1915
1917 {
1918 /* fits on first page of segment */
1919 if (bytesleft == 0)
1920 seg_offset = 0;
1921 else
1923 }
1924 else
1925 {
1926 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1929
1932
1933 if (bytesleft == 0)
1935 else
1937 }
1938
1940
1941 return result;
1942}
1943
1944/*
1945 * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
1946 */
1947static uint64
1949{
1952 uint32 offset;
1953 uint64 result;
1954
1956
1958 offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1959
1960 if (fullpages == 0)
1961 {
1962 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
1963 if (offset > 0)
1964 {
1965 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
1966 result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1967 }
1968 }
1969 else
1970 {
1971 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
1972 (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
1973 (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage; /* full pages */
1974 if (offset > 0)
1975 {
1976 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1977 result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1978 }
1979 }
1980
1981 return result;
1982}
1983
1984/*
1985 * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
1986 * unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
1987 * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
1988 * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
1989 * initialized properly.
1990 */
1991static void
1993{
1994 int nextidx;
2000 int npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
2001
2003
2004 /*
2005 * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
2006 * already.
2007 */
2009 {
2011
2012 /*
2013 * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
2014 * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet). Fall through if it's
2015 * already written out.
2016 */
2019 {
2020 /*
2021 * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
2022 * as we can without flushing, give up now.
2023 */
2024 if (opportunistic)
2025 break;
2026
2027 /* Advance shared memory write request position */
2032
2033 /*
2034 * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
2035 * need to write it or if someone else already did.
2036 */
2039 {
2040 /*
2041 * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
2042 * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
2043 * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
2044 * deadlock.
2045 */
2047
2049
2051
2054 {
2055 /* OK, someone wrote it already */
2057 }
2058 else
2059 {
2060 /* Have to write it ourselves */
2062 WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
2064 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
2068
2069 /*
2070 * Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data, per
2071 * update of pgWalUsage.
2072 */
2073 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
2074 }
2075 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
2077 continue;
2078 }
2079 }
2080
2081 /*
2082 * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
2083 * next output page.
2084 */
2087
2089
2091
2092 /*
2093 * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
2094 * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
2095 * zeroed but look valid.
2096 */
2099
2100 /*
2101 * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
2102 * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
2103 */
2105
2106 /*
2107 * Fill the new page's header
2108 */
2109 NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
2110
2111 /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2112 NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
2113 NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
2114
2115 /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2116
2117 /*
2118 * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
2119 */
2120 if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
2121 {
2123
2125 NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
2126 NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2127 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
2128 }
2129
2130 /*
2131 * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
2132 * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
2133 * holding a lock.
2134 */
2136
2139
2140 npages++;
2141 }
2143
2144#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2145 if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
2146 {
2147 elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%08X",
2149 }
2150#endif
2151}
2152
2153/*
2154 * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
2155 * checkpoint_completion_target.
2156 */
2157static void
2159{
2160 double target;
2161
2162 /*-------
2163 * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
2164 * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
2165 *
2166 * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
2167 * WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
2168 * secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
2169 * only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
2170 * one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
2171 * many smaller databases.)
2172 * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
2173 * number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
2174 *-------
2175 */
2178
2179 /* round down */
2180 CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
2181
2182 if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
2184}
2185
2186void
2192
2193void
2199
2200bool
2202{
2204 {
2205 GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
2206 return false;
2207 }
2208
2209 return true;
2210}
2211
2212/*
2213 * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
2214 * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
2215 */
2216static XLogSegNo
2218{
2221 double distance;
2223
2224 /*
2225 * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
2226 * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
2227 * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
2228 */
2233
2234 /*
2235 * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
2236 * estimated end of next checkpoint.
2237 *
2238 * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
2239 * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
2240 * every checkpoint.
2241 */
2243 /* add 10% for good measure. */
2244 distance *= 1.10;
2245
2246 recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
2248
2249 if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
2251 if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
2253
2254 return recycleSegNo;
2255}
2256
2257/*
2258 * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
2259 *
2260 * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
2261 * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
2262 * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
2263 *
2264 * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
2265 */
2266bool
2268{
2270
2272
2274 return true;
2275 return false;
2276}
2277
2278/*
2279 * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
2280 *
2281 * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
2282 * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
2283 * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
2284 * single one would do.
2285 *
2286 * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
2287 * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
2288 * write.
2289 */
2290static void
2292{
2293 bool ispartialpage;
2294 bool last_iteration;
2295 bool finishing_seg;
2296 int curridx;
2297 int npages;
2298 int startidx;
2300
2301 /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
2303
2304 /*
2305 * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
2306 */
2308
2309 /*
2310 * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
2311 * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
2312 * write() call. npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
2313 * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
2314 * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
2315 * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
2316 * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
2317 */
2318 npages = 0;
2319 startidx = 0;
2320 startoffset = 0;
2321
2322 /*
2323 * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
2324 * consider writing. Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
2325 * page, or last partially written page.
2326 */
2328
2329 while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
2330 {
2331 /*
2332 * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process. This could happen
2333 * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
2334 * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
2335 */
2337
2338 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
2339 elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%08X is past end of log %X/%08X",
2342
2343 /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
2346
2349 {
2350 /*
2351 * Switch to new logfile segment. We cannot have any pending
2352 * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
2353 */
2354 Assert(npages == 0);
2355 if (openLogFile >= 0)
2356 XLogFileClose();
2359 openLogTLI = tli;
2360
2361 /* create/use new log file */
2364 }
2365
2366 /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
2367 if (openLogFile < 0)
2368 {
2371 openLogTLI = tli;
2374 }
2375
2376 /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
2377 if (npages == 0)
2378 {
2379 /* first of group */
2380 startidx = curridx;
2383 }
2384 npages++;
2385
2386 /*
2387 * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
2388 * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
2389 * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
2390 * segment.
2391 */
2393
2396
2397 if (last_iteration ||
2400 {
2401 char *from;
2402 Size nbytes;
2403 Size nleft;
2406
2407 /* OK to write the page(s) */
2408 from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2409 nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2410 nleft = nbytes;
2411 do
2412 {
2413 errno = 0;
2414
2415 /*
2416 * Measure I/O timing to write WAL data, for pg_stat_io.
2417 */
2419
2423
2425 IOOP_WRITE, start, 1, written);
2426
2427 if (written <= 0)
2428 {
2429 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
2430 int save_errno;
2431
2432 if (errno == EINTR)
2433 continue;
2434
2435 save_errno = errno;
2438 errno = save_errno;
2439 ereport(PANIC,
2441 errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
2443 }
2444 nleft -= written;
2445 from += written;
2447 } while (nleft > 0);
2448
2449 npages = 0;
2450
2451 /*
2452 * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
2453 * fsync the segment immediately. This avoids having to go back
2454 * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
2455 * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
2456 * perform this fsync.
2457 *
2458 * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
2459 * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
2460 * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
2461 * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
2462 * checkpoint.
2463 */
2464 if (finishing_seg)
2465 {
2467
2468 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2470
2471 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; /* end of page */
2472
2473 if (XLogArchivingActive())
2475
2478
2479 /*
2480 * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
2481 * the last one. For speed, we first check using the local
2482 * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
2483 * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
2484 * recheck.
2485 */
2487 {
2488 (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
2491 }
2492 }
2493 }
2494
2495 if (ispartialpage)
2496 {
2497 /* Only asked to write a partial page */
2499 break;
2500 }
2502
2503 /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
2504 if (flexible && npages == 0)
2505 break;
2506 }
2507
2508 Assert(npages == 0);
2509
2510 /*
2511 * If asked to flush, do so
2512 */
2513 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
2515 {
2516 /*
2517 * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
2518 * have no open file or the wrong one. However, we do not need to
2519 * fsync more than one file.
2520 */
2523 {
2524 if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
2527 XLogFileClose();
2528 if (openLogFile < 0)
2529 {
2532 openLogTLI = tli;
2535 }
2536
2538 }
2539
2540 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2542
2544 }
2545
2546 /*
2547 * Update shared-memory status
2548 *
2549 * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
2550 * 'result' values. This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
2551 * code in a couple of places.
2552 */
2559
2560 /*
2561 * We write Write first, bar, then Flush. When reading, the opposite must
2562 * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
2563 * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
2564 */
2568
2569#ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
2570 {
2574
2580
2581 /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
2582 Assert(Write >= Flush);
2583
2584 /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
2585 Assert(Insert >= Write);
2586 }
2587#endif
2588}
2589
2590/*
2591 * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
2592 * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
2593 * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
2594 */
2595void
2597{
2598 XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
2599 bool sleeping;
2600 bool wakeup = false;
2602
2606 if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
2607 XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
2609
2610 /*
2611 * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
2612 * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
2613 */
2614 if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
2615 return;
2616
2617 /*
2618 * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
2619 * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
2620 * amount of time. Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
2621 * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
2622 */
2623 if (sleeping)
2624 wakeup = true;
2625 else
2626 {
2627 int flushblocks;
2628
2630
2631 flushblocks =
2633
2635 wakeup = true;
2636 }
2637
2638 if (wakeup)
2639 {
2640 volatile PROC_HDR *procglobal = ProcGlobal;
2641 ProcNumber walwriterProc = procglobal->walwriterProc;
2642
2643 if (walwriterProc != INVALID_PROC_NUMBER)
2644 SetLatch(&GetPGProcByNumber(walwriterProc)->procLatch);
2645 }
2646}
2647
2648/*
2649 * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
2650 * any replication slot.
2651 */
2652void
2659
2660
2661/*
2662 * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
2663 * replication slot.
2664 */
2667{
2668 XLogRecPtr retval;
2669
2673
2674 return retval;
2675}
2676
2677/*
2678 * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
2679 *
2680 * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
2681 * database is consistent.
2682 *
2683 * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
2684 * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
2685 */
2686static void
2688{
2689 /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
2690 if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
2691 return;
2692
2693 /*
2694 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
2695 * i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control file's
2696 * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
2697 * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
2698 * updated until crash recovery finishes. We only do this for the startup
2699 * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
2700 * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
2701 * available is replayed in this case. This also saves from extra locks
2702 * taken on the control file from the startup process.
2703 */
2705 {
2706 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2707 return;
2708 }
2709
2711
2712 /* update local copy */
2715
2717 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2718 else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2719 {
2722
2723 /*
2724 * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
2725 * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
2726 * would suffice for correctness. This also allows the 'force' case
2727 * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
2728 *
2729 * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
2730 * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
2731 * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page. Accepting such a
2732 * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
2733 * all. Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
2734 * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
2735 */
2737 if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2738 elog(WARNING,
2739 "xlog min recovery request %X/%08X is past current point %X/%08X",
2741
2742 /* update control file */
2744 {
2750
2752 errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%08X on timeline %u",
2755 }
2756 }
2758}
2759
2760/*
2761 * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
2762 *
2763 * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
2764 * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
2765 */
2766void
2768{
2772
2773 /*
2774 * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL. Therefore, instead of
2775 * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
2776 * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
2777 * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
2778 * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
2779 */
2780 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
2781 {
2782 UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
2783 return;
2784 }
2785
2786 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
2787 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2788 return;
2789
2790#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2791 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
2792 elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%08X; write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
2793 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2796#endif
2797
2799
2800 /*
2801 * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
2802 * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
2803 * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
2804 * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
2805 * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
2806 */
2807
2808 /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
2809 WriteRqstPtr = record;
2810
2811 /*
2812 * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
2813 * for us.
2814 */
2815 for (;;)
2816 {
2818
2819 /* done already? */
2821 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2822 break;
2823
2824 /*
2825 * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
2826 * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
2827 */
2829 if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
2833
2834 /*
2835 * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
2836 * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
2837 * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
2838 * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
2839 * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
2840 */
2842 {
2843 /*
2844 * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
2845 * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
2846 * us already.
2847 */
2848 continue;
2849 }
2850
2851 /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
2853 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2854 {
2856 break;
2857 }
2858
2859 /*
2860 * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
2861 * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
2862 * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
2863 * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
2864 *
2865 * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
2866 * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
2867 */
2868 if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
2870 {
2874
2875 /*
2876 * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
2877 * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
2878 * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
2879 * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
2880 * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
2881 * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
2882 * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
2883 * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
2884 */
2886 }
2887
2888 /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
2889 WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
2890 WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
2891
2892 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
2893
2895 /* done */
2896 break;
2897 }
2898
2900
2901 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
2903
2904 /*
2905 * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
2906 */
2907 if (waitLSNState &&
2911
2912 /*
2913 * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
2914 * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
2915 * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
2916 *
2917 * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
2918 * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
2919 * the whole system due to corruption on one data page. In particular, if
2920 * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
2921 * unable to restart the database at all! (This scenario actually
2922 * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.) As of 8.4, bad
2923 * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
2924 * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
2925 * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
2926 * bad LSN.
2927 *
2928 * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
2929 * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section. However,
2930 * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
2931 * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
2932 */
2933 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
2934 elog(ERROR,
2935 "xlog flush request %X/%08X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%08X",
2936 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2938
2939 /*
2940 * Cross-check XLogNeedsFlush(). Some of the checks of XLogFlush() and
2941 * XLogNeedsFlush() are duplicated, and this assertion ensures that these
2942 * remain consistent.
2943 */
2944 Assert(!XLogNeedsFlush(record));
2945}
2946
2947/*
2948 * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
2949 *
2950 * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
2951 * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
2952 * block, and write through the latest one of those. Thus, if async commits
2953 * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
2954 *
2955 * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
2956 * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
2957 * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
2958 * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
2959 *
2960 * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
2961 * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
2962 * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
2963 * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
2964 * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
2965 *
2966 * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
2967 *
2968 * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
2969 * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
2970 */
2971bool
2973{
2975 bool flexible = true;
2976 static TimestampTz lastflush;
2978 int flushblocks;
2980
2981 /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
2982 if (RecoveryInProgress())
2983 return false;
2984
2985 /*
2986 * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
2987 * so we can read it without a lock.
2988 */
2990
2991 /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
2995
2996 /* back off to last completed page boundary */
2997 WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2998
2999 /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
3001 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3002 {
3006 flexible = false; /* ensure it all gets written */
3007 }
3008
3009 /*
3010 * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
3011 * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
3012 * preventing the file from being deleted.
3013 */
3014 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3015 {
3016 if (openLogFile >= 0)
3017 {
3020 {
3021 XLogFileClose();
3022 }
3023 }
3024 return false;
3025 }
3026
3027 /*
3028 * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
3029 * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
3030 *
3031 * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
3032 * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up. Make sure the
3033 * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
3034 */
3036 flushblocks =
3038
3039 if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
3040 {
3041 /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
3042 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3043 lastflush = now;
3044 }
3046 {
3047 /*
3048 * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
3049 * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
3050 * commit to hit disk.
3051 */
3052 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3053 lastflush = now;
3054 }
3055 else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
3056 {
3057 /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
3058 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3059 lastflush = now;
3060 }
3061 else
3062 {
3063 /* no flushing, this time round */
3065 }
3066
3067#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
3068 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
3069 elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%08X; flush: %X/%08X, current is write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
3074#endif
3075
3077
3078 /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
3082 if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
3084 {
3086 }
3088
3090
3091 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
3093
3094 /*
3095 * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
3096 */
3097 if (waitLSNState &&
3101
3102 /*
3103 * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
3104 * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
3105 */
3107
3108 /*
3109 * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
3110 * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
3111 * avoid hibernating too early.
3112 */
3113 return true;
3114}
3115
3116/*
3117 * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given
3118 * position, or whether the minimum recovery point has been updated past
3119 * the given position.
3120 *
3121 * Returns true if a flush is still needed, or if the minimum recovery point
3122 * must be updated.
3123 *
3124 * It is possible that someone else is already in the process of flushing
3125 * that far, or has updated the minimum recovery point up to the given
3126 * position.
3127 */
3128bool
3130{
3131 /*
3132 * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
3133 * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
3134 * would need to be updated.
3135 *
3136 * Using XLogInsertAllowed() rather than RecoveryInProgress() matters for
3137 * the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, where WAL data is flushed.
3138 * This check should be consistent with the one in XLogFlush().
3139 */
3140 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
3141 {
3142 /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
3144 return false;
3145
3146 /*
3147 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
3148 * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control
3149 * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
3150 * here too. This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
3151 * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
3152 * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
3153 */
3155 {
3156 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3157 return false;
3158 }
3159
3160 /*
3161 * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
3162 * just return a conservative guess.
3163 */
3165 return true;
3169
3170 /*
3171 * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
3172 * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
3173 * file value if crash recovery is still running.
3174 */
3176 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3177
3178 /* check again */
3180 return false;
3181 else
3182 return true;
3183 }
3184
3185 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
3186 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3187 return false;
3188
3189 /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
3191
3192 /* check again */
3193 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3194 return false;
3195
3196 return true;
3197}
3198
3199/*
3200 * Try to make a given XLOG file segment exist.
3201 *
3202 * logsegno: identify segment.
3203 *
3204 * *added: on return, true if this call raised the number of extant segments.
3205 *
3206 * path: on return, this char[MAXPGPATH] has the path to the logsegno file.
3207 *
3208 * Returns -1 or FD of opened file. A -1 here is not an error; a caller
3209 * wanting an open segment should attempt to open "path", which usually will
3210 * succeed. (This is weird, but it's efficient for the callers.)
3211 */
3212static int
3214 bool *added, char *path)
3215{
3216 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3219 int fd;
3220 int save_errno;
3223
3224 Assert(logtli != 0);
3225
3227
3228 /*
3229 * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
3230 */
3231 *added = false;
3234 if (fd < 0)
3235 {
3236 if (errno != ENOENT)
3237 ereport(ERROR,
3239 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3240 }
3241 else
3242 return fd;
3243
3244 /*
3245 * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment. NOTE: it is possible that
3246 * another process is doing the same thing. If so, we will end up
3247 * pre-creating an extra log segment. That seems OK, and better than
3248 * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
3249 */
3250 elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
3251
3252 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3253
3254 unlink(tmppath);
3255
3258
3259 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3261 if (fd < 0)
3262 ereport(ERROR,
3264 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3265
3266 /* Measure I/O timing when initializing segment */
3268
3270 save_errno = 0;
3271 if (wal_init_zero)
3272 {
3273 ssize_t rc;
3274
3275 /*
3276 * Zero-fill the file. With this setting, we do this the hard way to
3277 * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated. On
3278 * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
3279 * doesn't allocate intermediate space. This way, we know that we
3280 * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
3281 * indirect blocks are down on disk. Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
3282 * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
3283 */
3285
3286 if (rc < 0)
3287 save_errno = errno;
3288 }
3289 else
3290 {
3291 /*
3292 * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
3293 * enough.
3294 */
3295 errno = 0;
3296 if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
3297 {
3298 /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
3300 }
3301 }
3303
3304 /*
3305 * A full segment worth of data is written when using wal_init_zero. One
3306 * byte is written when not using it.
3307 */
3309 io_start, 1,
3311
3312 if (save_errno)
3313 {
3314 /*
3315 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3316 */
3317 unlink(tmppath);
3318
3319 close(fd);
3320
3321 errno = save_errno;
3322
3323 ereport(ERROR,
3325 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3326 }
3327
3328 /* Measure I/O timing when flushing segment */
3330
3332 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3333 {
3334 save_errno = errno;
3335 close(fd);
3336 errno = save_errno;
3337 ereport(ERROR,
3339 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3340 }
3342
3344 IOOP_FSYNC, io_start, 1, 0);
3345
3346 if (close(fd) != 0)
3347 ereport(ERROR,
3349 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3350
3351 /*
3352 * Now move the segment into place with its final name. Cope with
3353 * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
3354 * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
3355 */
3357
3358 /*
3359 * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
3360 * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
3361 * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
3362 * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
3363 * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
3364 * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
3365 * CheckPointSegments.
3366 */
3369 logtli))
3370 {
3371 *added = true;
3372 elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
3373 }
3374 else
3375 {
3376 /*
3377 * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
3378 * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
3379 * caller opening the file may fail.
3380 */
3381 unlink(tmppath);
3382 elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
3383 }
3384
3385 return -1;
3386}
3387
3388/*
3389 * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
3390 *
3391 * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
3392 *
3393 * Returns FD of opened file.
3394 *
3395 * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
3396 * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
3397 * take down the system on failure). They will promote to PANIC if we are
3398 * in a critical section.
3399 */
3400int
3402{
3403 bool ignore_added;
3404 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3405 int fd;
3406
3407 Assert(logtli != 0);
3408
3410 if (fd >= 0)
3411 return fd;
3412
3413 /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
3416 if (fd < 0)
3417 ereport(ERROR,
3419 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3420 return fd;
3421}
3422
3423/*
3424 * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
3425 *
3426 * destsegno: identify segment to be created.
3427 *
3428 * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
3429 * a different timeline)
3430 *
3431 * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
3432 * zeros)
3433 *
3434 * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
3435 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
3436 * emplacing a bogus file.
3437 */
3438static void
3441 int upto)
3442{
3443 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3444 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3445 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
3446 int srcfd;
3447 int fd;
3448 int nbytes;
3449
3450 /*
3451 * Open the source file
3452 */
3455 if (srcfd < 0)
3456 ereport(ERROR,
3458 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3459
3460 /*
3461 * Copy into a temp file name.
3462 */
3463 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3464
3465 unlink(tmppath);
3466
3467 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3469 if (fd < 0)
3470 ereport(ERROR,
3472 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3473
3474 /*
3475 * Do the data copying.
3476 */
3477 for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
3478 {
3479 int nread;
3480
3481 nread = upto - nbytes;
3482
3483 /*
3484 * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
3485 * zeros.
3486 */
3487 if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
3488 memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
3489
3490 if (nread > 0)
3491 {
3492 int r;
3493
3494 if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
3495 nread = sizeof(buffer);
3497 r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
3498 if (r != nread)
3499 {
3500 if (r < 0)
3501 ereport(ERROR,
3503 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
3504 path)));
3505 else
3506 ereport(ERROR,
3508 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
3509 path, r, (Size) nread)));
3510 }
3512 }
3513 errno = 0;
3515 if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
3516 {
3517 int save_errno = errno;
3518
3519 /*
3520 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3521 */
3522 unlink(tmppath);
3523 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
3525
3526 ereport(ERROR,
3528 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3529 }
3531 }
3532
3534 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3537 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3539
3540 if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
3541 ereport(ERROR,
3543 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3544
3545 if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
3546 ereport(ERROR,
3548 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3549
3550 /*
3551 * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
3552 */
3554 elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
3555}
3556
3557/*
3558 * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
3559 *
3560 * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
3561 * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
3562 *
3563 * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
3564 * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
3565 * actual installation location or last segment searched.
3566 *
3567 * tmppath: initial name of file to install. It will be renamed into place.
3568 *
3569 * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
3570 * number at or after the passed numbers. If false, install the new segment
3571 * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
3572 *
3573 * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as. Fail if no
3574 * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
3575 * is false.)
3576 *
3577 * tli: The timeline on which the new segment should be installed.
3578 *
3579 * Returns true if the file was installed successfully. false indicates that
3580 * max_segno limit was exceeded, the startup process has disabled this
3581 * function for now, or an error occurred while renaming the file into place.
3582 */
3583static bool
3586{
3587 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3588 struct stat stat_buf;
3589
3590 Assert(tli != 0);
3591
3592 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3593
3596 {
3598 return false;
3599 }
3600
3601 if (!find_free)
3602 {
3603 /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
3604 durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
3605 }
3606 else
3607 {
3608 /* Find a free slot to put it in */
3609 while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
3610 {
3611 if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
3612 {
3613 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
3615 return false;
3616 }
3617 (*segno)++;
3618 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3619 }
3620 }
3621
3622 Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
3623 if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
3624 {
3626 /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
3627 return false;
3628 }
3629
3631
3632 return true;
3633}
3634
3635/*
3636 * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
3637 */
3638int
3640{
3641 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3642 int fd;
3643
3644 XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
3645
3648 if (fd < 0)
3649 ereport(PANIC,
3651 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3652
3653 return fd;
3654}
3655
3656/*
3657 * Close the current logfile segment for writing.
3658 */
3659static void
3661{
3662 Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
3663
3664 /*
3665 * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
3666 * the OS to release any cached pages. But do not do so if WAL archiving
3667 * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
3668 * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
3669 */
3670#if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
3671 if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
3673#endif
3674
3675 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
3676 {
3677 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
3678 int save_errno = errno;
3679
3681 errno = save_errno;
3682 ereport(PANIC,
3684 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
3685 }
3686
3687 openLogFile = -1;
3689}
3690
3691/*
3692 * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
3693 *
3694 * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
3695 * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
3696 * the current one. This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
3697 * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
3698 * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
3699 * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
3700 *
3701 * XLogFileInitInternal() can ereport(ERROR). All known causes indicate big
3702 * trouble; for example, a full filesystem is one cause. The checkpoint WAL
3703 * and/or ControlFile updates already completed. If a RequestCheckpoint()
3704 * initiated the present checkpoint and an ERROR ends this function, the
3705 * command that called RequestCheckpoint() fails. That's not ideal, but it's
3706 * not worth contorting more functions to use caller-specified elevel values.
3707 * (With or without RequestCheckpoint(), an ERROR forestalls some inessential
3708 * reporting and resource reclamation.)
3709 */
3710static void
3712{
3714 int lf;
3715 bool added;
3716 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3717 uint64 offset;
3718
3720 return; /* unlocked check says no */
3721
3723 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
3724 if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
3725 {
3726 _logSegNo++;
3727 lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
3728 if (lf >= 0)
3729 close(lf);
3730 if (added)
3732 }
3733}
3734
3735/*
3736 * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
3737 * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
3738 * existed while the server has been running, as this function always
3739 * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
3740 * 'tli' is only used in the error message.
3741 *
3742 * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
3743 * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
3744 * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
3745 * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
3746 */
3747void
3749{
3750 int save_errno = errno;
3751 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3752
3754 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3756
3757 if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
3758 {
3759 char filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
3760
3762 errno = save_errno;
3763 ereport(ERROR,
3765 errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
3766 filename)));
3767 }
3768 errno = save_errno;
3769}
3770
3771/*
3772 * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
3773 * since startup.
3774 *
3775 * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
3776 * with that.
3777 */
3780{
3781 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3782
3784 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3786
3787 return lastRemovedSegNo;
3788}
3789
3790/*
3791 * Return the oldest WAL segment on the given TLI that still exists in
3792 * XLOGDIR, or 0 if none.
3793 */
3796{
3797 DIR *xldir;
3798 struct dirent *xlde;
3800
3802 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3803 {
3806
3807 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
3808 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3809 continue;
3810
3811 /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
3814
3815 /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
3816 if (tli != file_tli)
3817 continue;
3818
3819 /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
3820 if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
3822 }
3823
3824 FreeDir(xldir);
3825 return oldest_segno;
3826}
3827
3828/*
3829 * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
3830 * given XLOG file has been removed.
3831 */
3832static void
3834{
3835 uint32 tli;
3836 XLogSegNo segno;
3837
3839
3841 if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
3842 XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
3844}
3845
3846/*
3847 * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
3848 *
3849 * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
3850 * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
3851 */
3852static void
3854{
3855 DIR *xldir;
3856 struct dirent *xlde;
3857
3858 elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
3859
3861 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3862 {
3863 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3864
3865 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
3866 continue;
3867
3868 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
3869 unlink(path);
3870 elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
3871 }
3872 FreeDir(xldir);
3873}
3874
3875/*
3876 * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
3877 *
3878 * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
3879 * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
3880 * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
3881 *
3882 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled
3883 * segments should be reused for this timeline.
3884 */
3885static void
3888{
3889 DIR *xldir;
3890 struct dirent *xlde;
3891 char lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
3894
3895 /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
3898
3899 /*
3900 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
3901 * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
3902 * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
3903 */
3905
3906 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
3907 lastoff);
3908
3910
3911 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3912 {
3913 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
3914 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
3915 !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3916 continue;
3917
3918 /*
3919 * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
3920 * deciding whether a segment is still needed. This ensures that we
3921 * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
3922 * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
3923 * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
3924 * complicated.
3925 *
3926 * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
3927 * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
3928 */
3929 if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
3930 {
3931 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
3932 {
3933 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
3934 UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
3935
3937 }
3938 }
3939 }
3940
3941 FreeDir(xldir);
3942}
3943
3944/*
3945 * Recycle or remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's
3946 * history.
3947 *
3948 * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
3949 * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
3950 * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
3951 * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
3952 * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
3953 * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
3954 * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
3955 * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
3956 *
3957 * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
3958 * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
3959 */
3960void
3962{
3963 DIR *xldir;
3964 struct dirent *xlde;
3965 char switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
3969
3970 /*
3971 * Initialize info about where to begin the work. This will recycle,
3972 * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
3973 */
3977
3978 /*
3979 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
3980 */
3982
3983 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
3984 switchseg);
3985
3987
3988 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3989 {
3990 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
3991 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3992 continue;
3993
3994 /*
3995 * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
3996 * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
3997 * new timeline.
3998 */
3999 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
4000 strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
4001 {
4002 /*
4003 * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
4004 * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
4005 * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
4006 * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
4007 */
4008 if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
4010 }
4011 }
4012
4013 FreeDir(xldir);
4014}
4015
4016/*
4017 * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
4018 *
4019 * segment_de is the dirent structure of the segment to recycle or remove.
4020 * recycleSegNo is the segment number to recycle up to. endlogSegNo is
4021 * the segment number of the current (or recent) end of WAL.
4022 *
4023 * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not
4024 * checked again with future callers of this function.
4025 *
4026 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled segments
4027 * should be used for this timeline.
4028 */
4029static void
4033{
4034 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4035#ifdef WIN32
4036 char newpath[MAXPGPATH];
4037#endif
4038 const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
4039
4040 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
4041
4042 /*
4043 * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
4044 * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
4045 * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
4046 */
4047 if (wal_recycle &&
4049 XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
4050 get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
4052 true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
4053 {
4055 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4056 segname)));
4058 /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
4059 (*endlogSegNo)++;
4060 }
4061 else
4062 {
4063 /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
4064 int rc;
4065
4067 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4068 segname)));
4069
4070#ifdef WIN32
4071
4072 /*
4073 * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
4074 * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
4075 * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
4076 * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
4077 * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
4078 *
4079 * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
4080 * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
4081 */
4082 snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
4083 if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
4084 {
4085 ereport(LOG,
4087 errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
4088 path)));
4089 return;
4090 }
4091 rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
4092#else
4093 rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
4094#endif
4095 if (rc != 0)
4096 {
4097 /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
4098 return;
4099 }
4101 }
4102
4104}
4105
4106/*
4107 * Verify whether pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
4108 * If the latter do not exist, recreate them.
4109 *
4110 * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
4111 * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
4112 * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
4113 *
4114 * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
4115 * policy decision was made not to. It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
4116 * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
4117 * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
4118 */
4119static void
4121{
4122 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4123 struct stat stat_buf;
4124
4125 /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
4126 if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
4127 !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4128 ereport(FATAL,
4130 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4131 XLOGDIR)));
4132
4133 /* Check for archive_status */
4134 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
4135 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4136 {
4137 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4138 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4139 ereport(FATAL,
4141 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4142 path)));
4143 }
4144 else
4145 {
4146 ereport(LOG,
4147 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4148 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4149 ereport(FATAL,
4151 errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4152 path)));
4153 }
4154
4155 /* Check for summaries */
4156 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
4157 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4158 {
4159 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4160 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4161 ereport(FATAL,
4162 (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4163 path)));
4164 }
4165 else
4166 {
4167 ereport(LOG,
4168 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4169 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4170 ereport(FATAL,
4171 (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4172 path)));
4173 }
4174}
4175
4176/*
4177 * Remove previous backup history files. This also retries creation of
4178 * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
4179 * failed earlier.
4180 */
4181static void
4183{
4184 DIR *xldir;
4185 struct dirent *xlde;
4186 char path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
4187
4189
4190 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4191 {
4192 if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
4193 {
4194 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
4195 {
4196 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
4197 xlde->d_name);
4198 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
4199 unlink(path);
4200 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
4201 }
4202 }
4203 }
4204
4205 FreeDir(xldir);
4206}
4207
4208/*
4209 * I/O routines for pg_control
4210 *
4211 * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
4212 * contents of pg_control. WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
4213 * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
4214 * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
4215 * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
4216 * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
4217 *
4218 * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
4219 * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
4220 * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct. We could split out the
4221 * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
4222 */
4223
4224static void
4225InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
4226{
4228
4229 /*
4230 * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
4231 * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
4232 * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
4233 * of an actual stored password.
4234 */
4236 ereport(PANIC,
4238 errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
4239
4240 memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4241 /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
4242 ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
4246
4247 /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
4256 ControlFile->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
4257}
4258
4259static void
4261{
4262 int fd;
4263 char buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE]; /* need not be aligned */
4264
4265 /*
4266 * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
4267 */
4270
4273
4279
4282
4285
4286 ControlFile->float8ByVal = true; /* vestigial */
4287
4288 /*
4289 * Initialize the default 'char' signedness.
4290 *
4291 * The signedness of the char type is implementation-defined. For instance
4292 * on x86 architecture CPUs, the char data type is typically treated as
4293 * signed by default, whereas on aarch architecture CPUs, it is typically
4294 * treated as unsigned by default. In v17 or earlier, we accidentally let
4295 * C implementation signedness affect persistent data. This led to
4296 * inconsistent results when comparing char data across different
4297 * platforms.
4298 *
4299 * This flag can be used as a hint to ensure consistent behavior for
4300 * pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char' type on disk,
4301 * especially in cross-platform replication scenarios.
4302 *
4303 * Newly created database clusters unconditionally set the default char
4304 * signedness to true. pg_upgrade changes this flag for clusters that were
4305 * initialized on signedness=false platforms. As a result,
4306 * signedness=false setting will become rare over time. If we had known
4307 * about this problem during the last development cycle that forced initdb
4308 * (v8.3), we would have made all clusters signed or all clusters
4309 * unsigned. Making pg_upgrade the only source of signedness=false will
4310 * cause the population of database clusters to converge toward that
4311 * retrospective ideal.
4312 */
4314
4315 /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
4321
4322 /*
4323 * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
4324 * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData). This reduces the odds of
4325 * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control. We'll still fail when we
4326 * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
4327 * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
4328 */
4329 memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
4330 memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4331
4334 if (fd < 0)
4335 ereport(PANIC,
4337 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
4339
4340 errno = 0;
4343 {
4344 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
4345 if (errno == 0)
4346 errno = ENOSPC;
4347 ereport(PANIC,
4349 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
4351 }
4353
4355 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
4356 ereport(PANIC,
4358 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
4361
4362 if (close(fd) != 0)
4363 ereport(PANIC,
4365 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
4367}
4368
4369static void
4371{
4372 pg_crc32c crc;
4373 int fd;
4374 char wal_segsz_str[20];
4375 int r;
4376
4377 /*
4378 * Read data...
4379 */
4381 O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
4382 if (fd < 0)
4383 ereport(PANIC,
4385 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
4387
4389 r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4390 if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
4391 {
4392 if (r < 0)
4393 ereport(PANIC,
4395 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
4397 else
4398 ereport(PANIC,
4400 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
4401 XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
4402 }
4404
4405 close(fd);
4406
4407 /*
4408 * Check for expected pg_control format version. If this is wrong, the
4409 * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
4410 * of bytes. Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
4411 * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
4412 */
4413
4415 ereport(FATAL,
4417 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4418 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
4419 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
4422 errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering. It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4423
4425 ereport(FATAL,
4427 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4428 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
4429 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
4431 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4432
4433 /* Now check the CRC. */
4438 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
4439
4440 if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
4441 ereport(FATAL,
4443 errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
4444
4445 /*
4446 * Do compatibility checking immediately. If the database isn't
4447 * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
4448 * possibly do any damage.
4449 */
4451 ereport(FATAL,
4453 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4454 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4455 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4456 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4457 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", ControlFile->catalog_version_no,
4458 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
4459 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4461 ereport(FATAL,
4463 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4464 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4465 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4466 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4467 "MAXALIGN", ControlFile->maxAlign,
4468 "MAXALIGN", MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
4469 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4471 ereport(FATAL,
4473 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4474 errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
4475 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4476 if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
4477 ereport(FATAL,
4479 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4480 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4481 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4482 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4483 "BLCKSZ", ControlFile->blcksz,
4484 "BLCKSZ", BLCKSZ),
4485 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4487 ereport(FATAL,
4489 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4490 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4491 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4492 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4493 "RELSEG_SIZE", ControlFile->relseg_size,
4494 "RELSEG_SIZE", RELSEG_SIZE),
4495 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4497 ereport(FATAL,
4499 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4500 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4501 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4502 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4503 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment,
4504 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT),
4505 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4507 ereport(FATAL,
4509 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4510 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4511 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4512 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4513 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", ControlFile->xlog_blcksz,
4514 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", XLOG_BLCKSZ),
4515 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4517 ereport(FATAL,
4519 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4520 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4521 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4522 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4523 "NAMEDATALEN", ControlFile->nameDataLen,
4524 "NAMEDATALEN", NAMEDATALEN),
4525 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4527 ereport(FATAL,
4529 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4530 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4531 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4532 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4533 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", ControlFile->indexMaxKeys,
4534 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
4535 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4537 ereport(FATAL,
4539 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4540 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4541 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4542 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4543 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size,
4544 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
4545 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4547 ereport(FATAL,
4549 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4550 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4551 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4552 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4553 "LOBLKSIZE", ControlFile->loblksize,
4554 "LOBLKSIZE", (int) LOBLKSIZE),
4555 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4556
4557 Assert(ControlFile->float8ByVal); /* vestigial, not worth an error msg */
4558
4560
4563 errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
4564 "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
4567 errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
4568
4570 SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
4572
4573 /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
4576 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4577 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4578 "min_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4579
4582 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4583 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4584 "max_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4585
4589
4591
4592 /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
4593 SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
4595}
4596
4597/*
4598 * Utility wrapper to update the control file. Note that the control
4599 * file gets flushed.
4600 */
4601static void
4606
4607/*
4608 * Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
4609 */
4610uint64
4616
4617/*
4618 * Returns the random nonce from control file.
4619 */
4620char *
4626
4627/*
4628 * Are checksums enabled for data pages?
4629 */
4630bool
4632{
4634 return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0);
4635}
4636
4637/*
4638 * Return true if the cluster was initialized on a platform where the
4639 * default signedness of char is "signed". This function exists for code
4640 * that deals with pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char'
4641 * type on disk (e.g., GIN and GiST indexes). See the comments in
4642 * WriteControlFile() for details.
4643 */
4644bool
4649
4650/*
4651 * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
4652 *
4653 * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
4654 * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
4655 * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
4656 * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
4657 * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
4658 */
4664
4665/*
4666 * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
4667 *
4668 * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
4669 * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
4670 * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
4671 * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
4672 * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
4673 *
4674 * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
4675 */
4676static int
4678{
4679 int xbuffers;
4680
4681 xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
4684 if (xbuffers < 8)
4685 xbuffers = 8;
4686 return xbuffers;
4687}
4688
4689/*
4690 * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
4691 */
4692bool
4694{
4695 /*
4696 * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
4697 */
4698 if (*newval == -1)
4699 {
4700 /*
4701 * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
4702 * be. We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
4703 */
4704 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4705 return true;
4706
4707 /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
4709 }
4710
4711 /*
4712 * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks. Prior to PostgreSQL
4713 * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
4714 * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
4715 * minimum. (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
4716 * helpful.)
4717 */
4718 if (*newval < 4)
4719 *newval = 4;
4720
4721 return true;
4722}
4723
4724/*
4725 * GUC check_hook for wal_consistency_checking
4726 */
4727bool
4729{
4730 char *rawstring;
4731 List *elemlist;
4732 ListCell *l;
4733 bool newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
4734
4735 /* Initialize the array */
4736 MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4737
4738 /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
4740
4741 /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
4743 {
4744 /* syntax error in list */
4745 GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
4748 return false;
4749 }
4750
4751 foreach(l, elemlist)
4752 {
4753 char *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
4754 int rmid;
4755
4756 /* Check for 'all'. */
4757 if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
4758 {
4759 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4760 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
4761 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4762 }
4763 else
4764 {
4765 /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
4766 bool found = false;
4767
4768 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4769 {
4770 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
4771 pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
4772 {
4773 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4774 found = true;
4775 break;
4776 }
4777 }
4778 if (!found)
4779 {
4780 /*
4781 * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
4782 * resource manager. Defer checking until
4783 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
4784 */
4786 {
4788 }
4789 else
4790 {
4791 GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
4794 return false;
4795 }
4796 }
4797 }
4798 }
4799
4802
4803 /* assign new value */
4804 *extra = guc_malloc(LOG, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4805 if (!*extra)
4806 return false;
4807 memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4808 return true;
4809}
4810
4811/*
4812 * GUC assign_hook for wal_consistency_checking
4813 */
4814void
4816{
4817 /*
4818 * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
4819 * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
4820 * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
4821 * assignment.
4822 *
4823 * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
4824 * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
4825 * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
4826 * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
4827 * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
4828 * module is loaded anyway.
4829 */
4831}
4832
4833/*
4834 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking: run after loading custom resource managers
4835 *
4836 * If any unknown resource managers were specified in the
4837 * wal_consistency_checking GUC, processing was deferred. Now that
4838 * shared_preload_libraries have been loaded, process wal_consistency_checking
4839 * again.
4840 */
4841void
4843{
4845
4847 {
4848 struct config_generic *guc;
4849
4850 guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
4851
4853
4854 set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
4856 guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
4857 GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
4858
4859 /* checking should not be deferred again */
4861 }
4862}
4863
4864/*
4865 * GUC show_hook for archive_command
4866 */
4867const char *
4869{
4870 if (XLogArchivingActive())
4871 return XLogArchiveCommand;
4872 else
4873 return "(disabled)";
4874}
4875
4876/*
4877 * GUC show_hook for in_hot_standby
4878 */
4879const char *
4881{
4882 /*
4883 * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
4884 * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query. The underlying
4885 * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
4886 * to the client.
4887 */
4888 return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
4889}
4890
4891/*
4892 * GUC show_hook for effective_wal_level
4893 */
4894const char *
4896{
4898 return "minimal";
4899
4900 /*
4901 * During recovery, effective_wal_level reflects the primary's
4902 * configuration rather than the local wal_level value.
4903 */
4904 if (RecoveryInProgress())
4905 return IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled() ? "logical" : "replica";
4906
4907 return XLogLogicalInfoActive() ? "logical" : "replica";
4908}
4909
4910/*
4911 * Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
4912 *
4913 * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
4914 * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists. As there's no
4915 * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
4916 * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
4917 * will then copy it to shared memory later.
4918 *
4919 * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
4920 * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
4921 */
4922void
4929
4930/*
4931 * Get the wal_level from the control file. For a standby, this value should be
4932 * considered as its active wal_level, because it may be different from what
4933 * was originally configured on standby.
4934 */
4937{
4938 return ControlFile->wal_level;
4939}
4940
4941/*
4942 * Initialization of shared memory for XLOG
4943 */
4944Size
4946{
4947 Size size;
4948
4949 /*
4950 * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
4951 * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
4952 * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
4953 * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
4954 *
4955 * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
4956 * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
4957 * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
4958 * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
4959 */
4960 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4961 {
4962 char buf[32];
4963
4964 snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
4965 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4967 if (XLOGbuffers == -1) /* failed to apply it? */
4968 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4970 }
4971 Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
4972
4973 /* XLogCtl */
4974 size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
4975
4976 /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
4977 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
4978 /* xlblocks array */
4979 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
4980 /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
4981 size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
4982 /* and the buffers themselves */
4983 size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
4984
4985 /*
4986 * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
4987 * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores. This lets us use this
4988 * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
4989 */
4990
4991 return size;
4992}
4993
4994void
4996{
4997 bool foundCFile,
4998 foundXLog;
4999 char *allocptr;
5000 int i;
5002
5003#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
5004
5005 /*
5006 * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
5007 * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
5008 * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
5009 */
5010 if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
5011 {
5013 "WAL Debug",
5016 }
5017#endif
5018
5019
5020 XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
5021 ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
5022
5025 ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
5026
5027 if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
5028 {
5029 /* both should be present or neither */
5031
5032 /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
5034
5035 if (localControlFile)
5037 return;
5038 }
5039 memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
5040
5041 /*
5042 * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
5043 * contents into shared memory.
5044 */
5045 if (localControlFile)
5046 {
5049 }
5050
5051 /*
5052 * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
5053 * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
5054 * needed here.
5055 */
5056 allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
5059
5060 for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
5061 {
5063 }
5064
5065 /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
5066 allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
5071
5072 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
5073 {
5077 }
5078
5079 /*
5080 * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
5081 * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
5082 * required for O_DIRECT.
5083 */
5087
5088 /*
5089 * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
5090 * in additional info.)
5091 */
5095 XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
5096
5103}
5104
5105/*
5106 * This func must be called ONCE on system install. It creates pg_control
5107 * and the initial XLOG segment.
5108 */
5109void
5110BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
5111{
5112 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5113 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
5114 XLogPageHeader page;
5116 XLogRecord *record;
5117 char *recptr;
5118 uint64 sysidentifier;
5119 struct timeval tv;
5120 pg_crc32c crc;
5121
5122 /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
5124
5125 /*
5126 * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
5127 * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
5128 * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get. (Think not to
5129 * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
5130 * to seed it other than the system clock value...) The upper half of the
5131 * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
5132 * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
5133 * PID for a little extra uniqueness. A person knowing this encoding can
5134 * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
5135 * perhaps be useful sometimes.
5136 */
5137 gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
5138 sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
5139 sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
5140 sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
5141
5142 memset(&buffer, 0, sizeof buffer);
5143 page = (XLogPageHeader) &buffer;
5144
5145 /*
5146 * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
5147 *
5148 * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
5149 * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
5150 * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
5151 */
5155 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
5157 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
5158 checkPoint.nextXid =
5160 checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
5161 checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5162 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 1;
5164 checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
5165 checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5166 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
5169 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
5171
5172 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5173 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5175 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5176 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5177 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5178 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5180
5181 /* Set up the XLOG page header */
5182 page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
5183 page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
5187 longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
5188 longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
5189 longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
5190
5191 /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
5192 recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
5193 record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
5194 record->xl_prev = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
5195 record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
5196 record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
5198 record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
5200 /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
5201 *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
5202 *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
5203 memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
5204 recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
5205 Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
5206
5208 COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
5209 COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
5210 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
5211 record->xl_crc = crc;
5212
5213 /* Create first XLOG segment file */
5216
5217 /*
5218 * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
5219 * close the file again in a moment.
5220 */
5221
5222 /* Write the first page with the initial record */
5223 errno = 0;
5225 if (write(openLogFile, &buffer, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
5226 {
5227 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
5228 if (errno == 0)
5229 errno = ENOSPC;
5230 ereport(PANIC,
5232 errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5233 }
5235
5237 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
5238 ereport(PANIC,
5240 errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5242
5243 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
5244 ereport(PANIC,
5246 errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5247
5248 openLogFile = -1;
5249
5250 /* Now create pg_control */
5251 InitControlFile(sysidentifier, data_checksum_version);
5252 ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
5253 ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
5254 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
5255
5256 /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
5258
5259 /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
5260 BootStrapCLOG();
5264
5265 /*
5266 * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
5267 * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
5268 */
5270}
5271
5272static char *
5274{
5276 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
5278
5279 return buf;
5280}
5281
5282/*
5283 * Initialize the first WAL segment on new timeline.
5284 */
5285static void
5287{
5288 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5291
5292 /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
5293 Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
5294
5295 /*
5296 * Update min recovery point one last time.
5297 */
5299
5300 /*
5301 * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
5302 * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
5303 * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
5304 * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
5305 */
5308
5309 /*
5310 * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
5311 * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
5312 * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
5313 * on the new timeline.
5314 */
5316 {
5317 /*
5318 * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
5319 *
5320 * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
5321 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
5322 * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
5323 */
5326 }
5327 else
5328 {
5329 /*
5330 * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
5331 * segment on the new timeline.
5332 */
5333 int fd;
5334
5336
5337 if (close(fd) != 0)
5338 {
5339 int save_errno = errno;
5340
5342 errno = save_errno;
5343 ereport(ERROR,
5345 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
5346 }
5347 }
5348
5349 /*
5350 * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
5351 * for the new segment.
5352 */
5355}
5356
5357/*
5358 * Perform cleanup actions at the conclusion of archive recovery.
5359 */
5360static void
5363{
5364 /*
5365 * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
5366 */
5369 "recovery_end_command",
5370 true,
5372
5373 /*
5374 * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
5375 *
5376 * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
5377 * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
5378 * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
5379 * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
5380 */
5382
5383 /*
5384 * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
5385 * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
5386 * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
5387 * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
5388 * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
5389 * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
5390 * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
5391 * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
5392 * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
5393 * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
5394 * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
5395 * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
5396 * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
5397 * caused such problems).
5398 *
5399 * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
5400 * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
5401 * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
5402 * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
5403 * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
5404 *
5405 * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
5406 * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
5407 * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
5408 * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
5409 */
5412 {
5413 char origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5415
5418
5420 {
5421 char origpath[MAXPGPATH];
5423 char partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
5424
5425 /*
5426 * If we're summarizing WAL, we can't rename the partial file
5427 * until the summarizer finishes with it, else it will fail.
5428 */
5429 if (summarize_wal)
5431
5433 snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
5434 snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
5435
5436 /*
5437 * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
5438 * file.
5439 */
5441
5444 }
5445 }
5446}
5447
5448/*
5449 * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
5450 * for various aspects of recovery operation.
5451 *
5452 * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
5453 * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
5454 * If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
5455 */
5456static void
5458{
5459 /*
5460 * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
5461 * wal_level.
5462 */
5464 {
5465 ereport(FATAL,
5467 errmsg("WAL was generated with \"wal_level=minimal\", cannot continue recovering"),
5468 errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set \"wal_level=minimal\" on the server."),
5469 errhint("Use a backup taken after setting \"wal_level\" to higher than \"minimal\".")));
5470 }
5471
5472 /*
5473 * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
5474 * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
5475 */
5477 {
5478 /* We ignore autovacuum_worker_slots when we make this test. */
5479 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
5482 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
5485 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
5488 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
5491 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
5494 }
5495}
5496
5497/*
5498 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
5499 */
5500void
5502{
5504 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5505 bool wasShutdown;
5506 bool didCrash;
5507 bool haveTblspcMap;
5508 bool haveBackupLabel;
5517 bool promoted = false;
5518 char timebuf[128];
5519
5520 /*
5521 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
5522 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
5523 */
5528
5529 /*
5530 * Check that contents look valid.
5531 */
5533 ereport(FATAL,
5535 errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
5536
5537 switch (ControlFile->state)
5538 {
5539 case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
5540
5541 /*
5542 * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
5543 * mode
5544 */
5546 (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
5548 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5549 break;
5550
5552 ereport(LOG,
5553 (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
5555 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5556 break;
5557
5558 case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
5559 ereport(LOG,
5560 (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5562 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5563 break;
5564
5566 ereport(LOG,
5567 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
5569 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5570 errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
5571 " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
5572 break;
5573
5575 ereport(LOG,
5576 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
5578 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5579 errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
5580 " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
5581 break;
5582
5583 case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
5584 ereport(LOG,
5585 (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5587 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5588 break;
5589
5590 default:
5591 ereport(FATAL,
5593 errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
5594 }
5595
5596 /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
5597#ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
5599 pg_usleep(60000000L);
5600#endif
5601
5602 /*
5603 * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
5604 * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
5605 * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
5606 */
5608
5609 /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
5613
5614 /*----------
5615 * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
5616 *
5617 * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
5618 * used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
5619 * bloat this path. This is done first as there is no point to sync
5620 * this temporary data.
5621 *
5622 * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
5623 * which we had not actually fsync'd yet. Therefore, a power failure in
5624 * the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
5625 * though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
5626 * persisted. To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
5627 */
5630 {
5633 didCrash = true;
5634 }
5635 else
5636 didCrash = false;
5637
5638 /*
5639 * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
5640 *
5641 * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
5642 * any. It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
5643 * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
5644 * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
5645 */
5648 checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
5649
5650 /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
5651 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5652 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5654 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5655 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5656 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5657 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5659 checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
5660
5661 /*
5662 * Clear out any old relcache cache files. This is *necessary* if we do
5663 * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
5664 * being out of sync with database reality. In theory we could leave them
5665 * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
5666 * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
5667 * first backend startup. These files needs to be removed from all
5668 * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
5669 * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
5670 * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
5671 * symlinks.
5672 */
5674
5675 /*
5676 * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
5677 * required resources.
5678 */
5680
5681 /*
5682 * Startup the logical decoding status with the last status stored in the
5683 * checkpoint record.
5684 */
5686
5687 /*
5688 * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
5689 * during crash recovery.
5690 */
5692
5693 /*
5694 * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
5695 * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
5696 */
5697 StartupCLOG();
5698
5699 /*
5700 * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
5701 * truncations.
5702 */
5704
5705 /*
5706 * Ditto for commit timestamps. Activate the facility if the setting is
5707 * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
5708 * timestamps done when the setting was disabled. This facility can be
5709 * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
5710 */
5713
5714 /*
5715 * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
5716 */
5718
5719 /*
5720 * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
5721 * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
5722 * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
5723 */
5727 else
5730
5731 /*
5732 * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
5733 * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
5734 * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
5735 * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
5736 * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
5737 * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
5738 * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
5739 * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
5740 * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
5741 * and regret later.
5742 */
5744
5745 /*
5746 * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
5747 * be able to work on entries generated by redo. Doing a scan before
5748 * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
5749 * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
5750 * replay. This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
5751 * of the on-disk two-phase data.
5752 */
5754
5755 /*
5756 * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
5757 * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
5758 * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
5759 *
5760 * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
5761 * already been restored from disk.
5762 *
5763 * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
5764 * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
5765 */
5766 if (didCrash)
5768 else
5770
5772
5775
5776 /* REDO */
5777 if (InRecovery)
5778 {
5779 /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
5783 else
5786
5787 /*
5788 * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
5789 * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
5790 * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
5791 * backup history file.
5792 *
5793 * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
5794 */
5796
5797 /*
5798 * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
5799 * has now been propagated into pg_control. We must get rid of the
5800 * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
5801 * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
5802 * to the backup start point. It seems prudent though to just rename
5803 * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
5804 */
5805 if (haveBackupLabel)
5806 {
5809 }
5810
5811 /*
5812 * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
5813 * symlinks have been created. We must get rid of the map file so
5814 * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
5815 * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
5816 * rather than delete it completely.
5817 */
5818 if (haveTblspcMap)
5819 {
5822 }
5823
5824 /*
5825 * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint. When doing crash
5826 * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL. Particularly, in
5827 * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
5828 * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint. However,
5829 * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
5830 * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
5831 * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
5832 * references when checking for data consistency.
5833 */
5835 {
5838 }
5839 else
5840 {
5843 }
5844
5845 /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
5847
5848 /*
5849 * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
5850 * reset. This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
5851 * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
5852 * garbage is left over from before.
5853 */
5855
5856 /*
5857 * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
5858 * behind by crashed backends.
5859 */
5861
5862 /*
5863 * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
5864 * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
5865 * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
5866 * running-xacts WAL record.
5867 */
5869 {
5870 TransactionId *xids;
5871 int nxids;
5872
5874 (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
5875
5877
5878 if (wasShutdown)
5880 else
5881 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
5883
5884 /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
5886
5887 /*
5888 * Startup subtrans only. CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
5889 * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
5890 * during recovery and need not be started yet.
5891 */
5893
5894 /*
5895 * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
5896 * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
5897 * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
5898 * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
5899 */
5900 if (wasShutdown)
5901 {
5903 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
5904
5905 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
5907
5908 /*
5909 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
5910 * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
5911 * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
5912 * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
5913 */
5914 running.xcnt = nxids;
5915 running.subxcnt = 0;
5917 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5919 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5920 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
5921 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
5922 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
5923 running.xids = xids;
5924
5926 }
5927 }
5928
5929 /*
5930 * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
5931 */
5933 performedWalRecovery = true;
5934 }
5935 else
5936 performedWalRecovery = false;
5937
5938 /*
5939 * Finish WAL recovery.
5940 */
5942 EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
5943 EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
5944 abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
5945 missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
5946
5947 /*
5948 * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
5949 * up.
5950 */
5951 set_ps_display("");
5952
5953 /*
5954 * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
5955 * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
5956 * the point where the database is consistent. For regular online
5957 * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
5958 * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
5959 * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
5960 * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
5961 * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica). For
5962 * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
5963 * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
5964 * to false.
5965 *
5966 * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
5967 * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
5968 * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
5969 * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
5970 */
5971 if (InRecovery &&
5974 {
5975 /*
5976 * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
5977 * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
5978 * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
5979 * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
5980 */
5982 {
5984 ereport(FATAL,
5986 errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
5987 errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
5988 else
5989 ereport(FATAL,
5991 errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
5992 }
5993 }
5994
5995 /*
5996 * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
5997 * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
5998 * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
5999 * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
6000 * end-of-recovery steps fail.
6001 */
6002 if (InRecovery)
6004
6005 /*
6006 * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
6007 * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
6008 * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
6009 */
6011
6012 /*
6013 * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
6014 * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
6015 */
6017
6018 /*
6019 * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
6020 *
6021 * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID. This handles a
6022 * couple of issues. If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
6023 * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
6024 * it a unique new ID. Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
6025 * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
6026 * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
6027 * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that. We can dodge the
6028 * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
6029 *
6030 * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
6031 */
6032 newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
6034 {
6036 ereport(LOG,
6037 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
6038
6039 /*
6040 * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment. (Note that we also
6041 * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
6042 * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
6043 */
6045
6046 /*
6047 * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
6048 * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
6049 */
6050 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
6052
6053 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
6055
6056 /*
6057 * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
6058 * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
6059 * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
6060 * servers. If we crash before actually switching to the new
6061 * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
6062 * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
6063 * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
6064 * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
6065 */
6067 EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6068
6069 ereport(LOG,
6070 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
6071 }
6072
6073 /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
6078
6079 /*
6080 * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
6081 * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
6082 * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
6083 * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
6084 */
6086 {
6087 /*
6088 * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
6089 * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
6090 * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
6091 * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
6092 * disregard.
6093 */
6094 Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
6097 }
6098
6099 /*
6100 * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
6101 * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
6102 * previous incarnation.
6103 */
6104 Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
6106 Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
6107
6108 /*
6109 * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
6110 * record spans, not the one it starts in. The last block is indeed the
6111 * one we want to use.
6112 */
6113 if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
6114 {
6115 char *page;
6116 int len;
6117 int firstIdx;
6118
6120 len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
6122
6123 /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
6124 page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
6125 memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
6126 memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
6127
6130 }
6131 else
6132 {
6133 /*
6134 * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
6135 * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
6136 * buffer.
6137 */
6139 }
6140
6141 /*
6142 * Update local and shared status. This is OK to do without any locks
6143 * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
6144 */
6151
6152 /*
6153 * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
6154 */
6156
6157 /*
6158 * Okay, we're officially UP.
6159 */
6160 InRecovery = false;
6161
6162 /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
6165
6166 /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
6171
6172 /*
6173 * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby. (commit
6174 * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
6175 */
6178
6179 /*
6180 * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
6181 */
6182 TrimCLOG();
6183 TrimMultiXact();
6184
6185 /*
6186 * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions. This needs to
6187 * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
6188 * it may be possible that we have to recover some transactions from it.
6189 */
6191
6192 /* Shut down xlogreader */
6194
6195 /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
6197
6198 /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
6200 {
6203 }
6204
6205 /*
6206 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
6207 * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
6208 * record is written.
6209 */
6210 Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
6212
6213 /*
6214 * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
6215 */
6218
6219 /*
6220 * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
6221 * backends to write WAL.
6222 */
6224
6225 /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
6228
6229 /*
6230 * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
6231 * commit timestamp.
6232 */
6234
6235 /*
6236 * Update logical decoding status in shared memory and write an
6237 * XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE, if necessary.
6238 */
6240
6241 /* Clean up EndOfWalRecoveryInfo data to appease Valgrind leak checking */
6242 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage)
6243 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage);
6244 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6246
6247 /*
6248 * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
6249 *
6250 * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
6251 * consequence. SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
6252 * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
6253 * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
6254 * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
6255 * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
6256 * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
6257 *
6258 * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
6259 * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
6260 * updates to shared memory.
6261 */
6264
6268
6271
6272 /*
6273 * Wake up the checkpointer process as there might be a request to disable
6274 * logical decoding by concurrent slot drop.
6275 */
6277
6278 /*
6279 * Wake up all waiters. They need to report an error that recovery was
6280 * ended before reaching the target LSN.
6281 */
6285
6286 /*
6287 * Shutdown the recovery environment. This must occur after
6288 * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
6289 * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
6290 * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
6291 * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage. This is
6292 * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
6293 * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
6294 */
6297
6298 /*
6299 * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
6300 * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
6301 */
6302 WalSndWakeup(true, true);
6303
6304 /*
6305 * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
6306 * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
6307 * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
6308 * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
6309 */
6310 if (promoted)
6312}
6313
6314/*
6315 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we switch from crash
6316 * recovery to archive recovery mode. Updates the control file accordingly.
6317 */
6318void
6320{
6321 /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
6324 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6325 {
6326 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6327 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
6328 }
6329 /* update local copy */
6332
6333 /*
6334 * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
6335 * this point.
6336 */
6338
6340
6341 /*
6342 * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
6343 * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
6344 */
6348
6350}
6351
6352/*
6353 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we reach the end of backup.
6354 * Updates the control file accordingly.
6355 */
6356void
6358{
6359 /*
6360 * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
6361 * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
6362 * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery). Reset
6363 * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
6364 * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
6365 * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
6366 */
6368
6369 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6370 {
6371 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6373 }
6374
6379
6381}
6382
6383/*
6384 * Perform whatever XLOG actions are necessary at end of REDO.
6385 *
6386 * The goal here is to make sure that we'll be able to recover properly if
6387 * we crash again. If we choose to write a checkpoint, we'll write a shutdown
6388 * checkpoint rather than an on-line one. This is not particularly critical,
6389 * but since we may be assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows
6390 * us to have the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
6391 * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
6392 */
6393static bool
6395{
6396 bool promoted = false;
6397
6398 /*
6399 * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
6400 *
6401 * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
6402 * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
6403 * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
6404 * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
6405 * checking in xlog_redo.
6406 *
6407 * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
6408 * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
6409 * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
6410 */
6413 {
6414 promoted = true;
6415
6416 /*
6417 * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
6418 * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
6419 * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
6420 * could continue to be for minutes after this. That sounds strange,
6421 * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
6422 * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
6423 * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
6424 */
6426 }
6427 else
6428 {
6432 }
6433
6434 return promoted;
6435}
6436
6437/*
6438 * Is the system still in recovery?
6439 *
6440 * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
6441 * shared memory.
6442 */
6443bool
6445{
6446 /*
6447 * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
6448 * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
6449 * shared variable has once been seen false.
6450 */
6452 return false;
6453 else
6454 {
6455 /*
6456 * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
6457 * shared variable.
6458 */
6459 volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
6460
6461 LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
6462
6463 /*
6464 * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
6465 * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
6466 * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
6467 */
6468
6470 }
6471}
6472
6473/*
6474 * Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
6475 *
6476 * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
6477 * file. See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
6478 */
6481{
6482 RecoveryState retval;
6483
6485 retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
6487
6488 return retval;
6489}
6490
6491/*
6492 * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
6493 *
6494 * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
6495 * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
6496 * within specific processes regardless of the global state.
6497 */
6498bool
6500{
6501 /*
6502 * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
6503 * return it. This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
6504 * done.
6505 */
6506 if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
6507 return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
6508
6509 /*
6510 * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
6511 */
6512 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6513 return false;
6514
6515 /*
6516 * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
6517 * no need to keep checking.
6518 */
6520 return true;
6521}
6522
6523/*
6524 * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
6525 *
6526 * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
6527 * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
6528 *
6529 * Returns the previous value of LocalXLogInsertAllowed.
6530 */
6531static int
6533{
6535
6537
6538 return oldXLogAllowed;
6539}
6540
6541/*
6542 * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
6543 *
6544 * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
6545 */
6548{
6549 XLogRecPtr ptr;
6550
6551 /*
6552 * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
6553 * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
6554 * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
6555 * the lock.
6556 */
6558 ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
6560
6561 if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
6562 RedoRecPtr = ptr;
6563
6564 return RedoRecPtr;
6565}
6566
6567/*
6568 * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
6569 * full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
6570 *
6571 * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
6572 * possibly out-of-date or, indeed, uninitialized, in which case they will
6573 * be InvalidXLogRecPtr and false, respectively. XLogInsertRecord will
6574 * re-check them against up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
6575 */
6576void
6582
6583/*
6584 * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
6585 *
6586 * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
6587 * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
6588 * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
6589 * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
6590 */
6593{
6595
6599
6600 return recptr;
6601}
6602
6603/*
6604 * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
6605 * position known to be fsync'd to disk. This should only be used on a
6606 * system that is known not to be in recovery.
6607 */
6610{
6612
6614
6615 /*
6616 * If we're writing and flushing WAL, the time line can't be changing, so
6617 * no lock is required.
6618 */
6619 if (insertTLI)
6621
6622 return LogwrtResult.Flush;
6623}
6624
6625/*
6626 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine -- Returns the current timeline of a system that
6627 * is not in recovery.
6628 */
6631{
6633
6634 /* Since the value can't be changing, no lock is required. */
6635 return XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
6636}
6637
6638/*
6639 * GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet -- If the system is not in recovery, returns
6640 * the WAL insertion timeline; else, returns 0. Wherever possible, use
6641 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine() instead, since it's cheaper. Note that this
6642 * function decides recovery has ended as soon as the insert TLI is set, which
6643 * happens before we set XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.
6644 */
6656
6657/*
6658 * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
6659 * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
6660 * important.
6661 *
6662 * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
6663 * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
6664 */
6667{
6669 int i;
6670
6671 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
6672 {
6674
6675 /*
6676 * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
6677 * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
6678 * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
6679 */
6682 LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
6683
6684 if (res < last_important)
6685 res = last_important;
6686 }
6687
6688 return res;
6689}
6690
6691/*
6692 * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
6693 */
6696{
6697 pg_time_t result;
6698
6699 /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
6701 result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
6704
6705 return result;
6706}
6707
6708/*
6709 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
6710 */
6711void
6713{
6714 /*
6715 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
6716 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
6717 */
6722
6723 /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
6725 (errmsg("shutting down")));
6726
6727 /*
6728 * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
6729 */
6731
6732 /*
6733 * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state. This prevents commands
6734 * from writing new WAL.
6735 */
6737
6738 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6740 else
6741 {
6742 /*
6743 * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
6744 * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
6745 * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
6746 * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
6747 */
6748 if (XLogArchivingActive())
6749 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
6750
6752 }
6753}
6754
6755/*
6756 * Format checkpoint request flags as a space-separated string for
6757 * log messages.
6758 */
6759static const char *
6761{
6762 static char buf[128];
6763
6764 snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
6765 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
6766 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
6767 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
6768 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
6769 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
6770 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
6771 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
6772 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "");
6773
6774 return buf;
6775}
6776
6777/*
6778 * Log start of a checkpoint.
6779 */
6780static void
6782{
6783 if (restartpoint)
6784 ereport(LOG,
6785 /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
6786 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s",
6787 CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
6788 else
6789 ereport(LOG,
6790 /* translator: the placeholder shows checkpoint options */
6791 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s",
6792 CheckpointFlagsString(flags))));
6793}
6794
6795/*
6796 * Log end of a checkpoint.
6797 */
6798static void
6800{
6801 long write_msecs,
6802 sync_msecs,
6807
6809
6812
6815
6816 /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
6819
6820 /*
6821 * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for. Only
6822 * continue if a log message is to be written.
6823 */
6824 if (!log_checkpoints)
6825 return;
6826
6829
6830 /*
6831 * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
6832 * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
6833 */
6835
6840 average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
6841
6842 /*
6843 * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
6844 * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
6845 * this moment.
6846 */
6847 if (restartpoint)
6848 ereport(LOG,
6849 (errmsg("restartpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6850 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6851 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6852 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6853 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6854 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6855 CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
6862 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6863 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6864 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6866 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6867 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6868 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6869 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6872 else
6873 ereport(LOG,
6874 (errmsg("checkpoint complete:%s: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6875 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6876 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6877 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6878 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6879 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6880 CheckpointFlagsString(flags),
6887 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6888 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6889 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6891 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6892 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6893 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6894 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6897}
6898
6899/*
6900 * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
6901 *
6902 * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
6903 * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
6904 */
6905static void
6907{
6908 /*
6909 * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
6910 * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
6911 * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
6912 * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
6913 * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
6914 * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
6915 * more.
6916 *
6917 * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
6918 * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
6919 *
6920 * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
6921 * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
6922 * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
6923 * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
6924 * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
6925 * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
6926 * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
6927 * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
6928 * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
6929 */
6930 PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
6931 if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
6933 else
6935 (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
6936}
6937
6938/*
6939 * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint. Note that
6940 * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called
6941 * from a critical section.
6942 */
6943static void
6945{
6946 /*
6947 * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
6948 * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints. Updating the ps display is
6949 * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
6950 * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
6951 * process.
6952 */
6954 return;
6955
6956 if (reset)
6957 set_ps_display("");
6958 else
6959 {
6960 char activitymsg[128];
6961
6962 snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
6963 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
6964 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
6965 restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
6967 }
6968}
6969
6970
6971/*
6972 * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
6973 *
6974 * flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
6975 * CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
6976 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
6977 * CHECKPOINT_FAST: finish the checkpoint ASAP, ignoring
6978 * checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
6979 * CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
6980 * since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
6981 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
6982 * CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
6983 *
6984 * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
6985 * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
6986 * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
6987 *
6988 * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. An XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
6989 * record is inserted into WAL at the logical location of the checkpoint, before
6990 * flushing anything to disk, and when the checkpoint is eventually completed,
6991 * and it is from this point that WAL replay will begin in the case of a recovery
6992 * from this checkpoint. Once everything is written to disk, an
6993 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE record is written to complete the checkpoint, and
6994 * points back to the earlier XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO record. This mechanism allows
6995 * other write-ahead log records to be written while the checkpoint is in
6996 * progress, but we must be very careful about order of operations. This function
6997 * may take many minutes to execute on a busy system.
6998 *
6999 * On the other hand, when shutdown is true, concurrent insertion into the
7000 * write-ahead log is impossible, so there is no need for two separate records.
7001 * In this case, we only insert an XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record, and it's
7002 * both the record marking the completion of the checkpoint and the location
7003 * from which WAL replay would begin if needed.
7004 *
7005 * Returns true if a new checkpoint was performed, or false if it was skipped
7006 * because the system was idle.
7007 */
7008bool
7010{
7011 bool shutdown;
7012 CheckPoint checkPoint;
7016 uint32 freespace;
7020 int nvxids;
7021 int oldXLogAllowed = 0;
7022
7023 /*
7024 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
7025 * issued at a different time.
7026 */
7028 shutdown = true;
7029 else
7030 shutdown = false;
7031
7032 /* sanity check */
7033 if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
7034 elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
7035
7036 /*
7037 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7038 *
7039 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7040 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7041 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7042 */
7045
7046 /*
7047 * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
7048 * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer. Note that
7049 * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
7050 * checkpoint is needed.
7051 */
7053
7054 /* Run these points outside the critical section. */
7055 INJECTION_POINT("create-checkpoint-initial", NULL);
7056 INJECTION_POINT_LOAD("create-checkpoint-run");
7057
7058 /*
7059 * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
7060 */
7062
7063 if (shutdown)
7064 {
7069 }
7070
7071 /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
7072 MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
7073 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
7074
7075 /*
7076 * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
7077 * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
7078 * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
7079 */
7081 checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(false, true);
7082 else
7084
7085 /*
7086 * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
7087 * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
7088 */
7090
7091 /*
7092 * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
7093 * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it. The idea here is to
7094 * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
7095 */
7097 CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
7098 {
7100 {
7103 (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
7104 return false;
7105 }
7106 }
7107
7108 /*
7109 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
7110 * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
7111 * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
7112 */
7113 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7115
7117 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7119 else
7120 checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
7121
7122 /*
7123 * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
7124 */
7126
7127 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
7128 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
7129
7130 if (shutdown)
7131 {
7133
7134 /*
7135 * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
7136 *
7137 * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
7138 * WAL insertion.
7139 */
7140 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
7141 if (freespace == 0)
7142 {
7145 else
7147 }
7148 checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
7149
7150 /*
7151 * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
7152 * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
7153 *
7154 * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
7155 * left pointing past where it really needs to point. This is okay;
7156 * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
7157 * that it didn't really need to. We can't postpone advancing
7158 * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
7159 * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
7160 * the checkpoint.
7161 */
7162 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7163 }
7164
7165 /*
7166 * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
7167 * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
7168 */
7170
7171 /*
7172 * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
7173 * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7174 * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
7175 * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
7176 * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
7177 * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
7178 * mark the redo point.
7179 */
7180 if (!shutdown)
7181 {
7182 /* Include WAL level in record for WAL summarizer's benefit. */
7186
7187 /*
7188 * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
7189 * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
7190 * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
7191 * checkpoint is complete.
7192 */
7193 checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
7194 }
7195
7196 /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
7198 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7200
7201 /*
7202 * If enabled, log checkpoint start. We postpone this until now so as not
7203 * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
7204 */
7205 if (log_checkpoints)
7206 LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
7207
7208 INJECTION_POINT_CACHED("create-checkpoint-run", NULL);
7209
7210 /* Update the process title */
7211 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
7212
7214
7215 /*
7216 * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
7217 *
7218 * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
7219 * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
7220 * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
7221 * there.
7222 */
7224 checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
7225 checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
7228
7233
7235 checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
7236 if (!shutdown)
7237 checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
7239
7241
7243 &checkPoint.nextMulti,
7244 &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
7245 &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
7246 &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
7247
7248 /*
7249 * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
7250 * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
7251 *
7252 * This I/O could fail for various reasons. If so, we will fail to
7253 * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
7254 * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
7255 */
7257
7258 /*
7259 * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
7260 * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
7261 * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
7262 * performing those groups of actions.
7263 *
7264 * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
7265 * that are currently in commit critical sections. If an xact inserted
7266 * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
7267 * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
7268 * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact. So
7269 * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
7270 * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
7271 *
7272 * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
7273 * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
7274 * to wait for. But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
7275 * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
7276 * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
7277 * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
7278 * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
7279 * minimizing lock contention.)
7280 *
7281 * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
7282 * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
7283 * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
7284 * clog and we will correctly flush the update below. So we cannot miss
7285 * any xacts we need to wait for.
7286 */
7288 if (nvxids > 0)
7289 {
7290 do
7291 {
7292 /*
7293 * Keep absorbing fsync requests while we wait. There could even
7294 * be a deadlock if we don't, if the process that prevents the
7295 * checkpoint is trying to add a request to the queue.
7296 */
7298
7300 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7304 }
7305 pfree(vxids);
7306
7307 CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
7308
7310 if (nvxids > 0)
7311 {
7312 do
7313 {
7315
7317 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7321 }
7322 pfree(vxids);
7323
7324 /*
7325 * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
7326 * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
7327 * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
7328 *
7329 * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
7330 * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
7331 */
7334
7336
7337 /*
7338 * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
7339 */
7341 XLogRegisterData(&checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
7345
7347
7348 /*
7349 * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
7350 * overwritten at next startup. No-one should even try, this just allows
7351 * sanity-checking. In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
7352 * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
7353 * recovery.
7354 */
7355 if (shutdown)
7356 {
7357 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7359 else
7360 LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
7361 }
7362
7363 /*
7364 * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
7365 * = end of actual checkpoint record.
7366 */
7367 if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
7368 ereport(PANIC,
7369 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
7370
7371 /*
7372 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7373 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7374 */
7376
7377 /*
7378 * Update the control file.
7379 */
7381 if (shutdown)
7384 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
7385 /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
7388
7389 /*
7390 * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
7391 * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
7392 * for debugging purposes.
7393 */
7395
7398
7399 /*
7400 * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
7401 * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
7402 */
7404
7405 /*
7406 * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
7407 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
7408 * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
7409 * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
7410 * happen before it can be summarized.
7411 *
7412 * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
7413 * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
7414 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
7415 * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7416 * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
7417 * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
7418 * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
7419 * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
7420 * record.
7421 */
7423
7424 /*
7425 * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
7426 */
7428
7429 /*
7430 * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
7431 * exists.
7432 */
7435
7436 INJECTION_POINT("checkpoint-before-old-wal-removal", NULL);
7437
7438 /*
7439 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
7440 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7441 */
7447 {
7448 /*
7449 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7450 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7451 */
7454 }
7455 _logSegNo--;
7457 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
7458
7459 /*
7460 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7461 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7462 */
7463 if (!shutdown)
7465
7466 /*
7467 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7468 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7469 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7470 * in subtrans.c). During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
7471 * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7472 */
7473 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7475
7476 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7477 LogCheckpointEnd(false, flags);
7478
7479 /* Reset the process title */
7480 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
7481
7483 NBuffers,
7487
7488 return true;
7489}
7490
7491/*
7492 * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
7493 * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
7494 * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete.
7495 *
7496 * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
7497 * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
7498 */
7499static void
7501{
7504
7505 /* sanity check */
7506 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7507 elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
7508
7509 xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7510 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
7511
7513 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7514 xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
7516
7518
7522
7524
7525 /*
7526 * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
7527 * changes to this point.
7528 */
7531 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
7534
7536}
7537
7538/*
7539 * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message.
7540 *
7541 * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page
7542 * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point.
7543 * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record
7544 * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical
7545 * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind". So the first action after
7546 * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type
7547 * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader
7548 * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added
7549 * to the page header where the record occurs. xlogreader has an ad-hoc
7550 * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we
7551 * use here.
7552 *
7553 * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to
7554 * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped
7555 * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the
7556 * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten.
7557 *
7558 * 'aborted_lsn' is the beginning position of the record that was incomplete.
7559 * It is included in the WAL record. 'pagePtr' and 'newTLI' point to the
7560 * beginning of the XLOG page where the record is to be inserted. They must
7561 * match the current WAL insert position, they're passed here just so that we
7562 * can verify that.
7563 */
7564static XLogRecPtr
7567{
7572
7573 /* sanity checks */
7574 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7575 elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
7576 if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
7577 elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%08X",
7579
7580 /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
7581 startPos = pagePtr;
7584 else
7587 if (recptr != startPos)
7588 elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%08X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
7590
7592
7593 /*
7594 * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
7595 * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
7596 *
7597 * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
7598 * insertion lock is just pro forma.
7599 */
7604
7605 /*
7606 * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
7607 * page. We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
7608 * allowed to write WAL yet.
7609 */
7611 xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
7612 xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7615
7616 /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
7617 if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
7618 elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%08X",
7620
7622
7624
7625 return recptr;
7626}
7627
7628/*
7629 * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
7630 *
7631 * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
7632 * recovery restartpoints.
7633 */
7634static void
7636{
7642
7643 /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
7651 CheckPointBuffers(flags);
7652
7653 /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
7659
7660 /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
7662}
7663
7664/*
7665 * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
7666 *
7667 * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
7668 * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
7669 * not. If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
7670 * CreateRestartPoint can consult it. (Note that the latter function is
7671 * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
7672 * startup process.)
7673 */
7674static void
7676{
7677 /*
7678 * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
7679 * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
7680 * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
7681 * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
7682 * later.
7683 */
7685 {
7686 elog(DEBUG2,
7687 "could not record restart point at %X/%08X because there are unresolved references to invalid pages",
7688 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
7689 return;
7690 }
7691
7692 /*
7693 * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
7694 * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
7695 */
7699 XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
7701}
7702
7703/*
7704 * Establish a restartpoint if possible.
7705 *
7706 * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
7707 * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
7708 * replaying the entire recovery log.
7709 *
7710 * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
7711 * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
7712 * restartpoint.
7713 */
7714bool
7716{
7717 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7718 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7719 CheckPoint lastCheckPoint;
7723 TimeLineID replayTLI;
7724 XLogRecPtr endptr;
7727
7728 /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
7730
7731 /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
7733 lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7734 lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7735 lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
7737
7738 /*
7739 * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
7740 * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
7741 */
7742 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7743 {
7745 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
7746 return false;
7747 }
7748
7749 /*
7750 * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
7751 * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
7752 * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
7753 * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
7754 * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
7755 * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
7756 * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
7757 * immediate shutdown, though.
7758 *
7759 * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
7760 * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
7761 * side-effect.
7762 */
7763 if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
7764 lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
7765 {
7767 errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%08X",
7768 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)));
7769
7771 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7772 {
7777 }
7778 return false;
7779 }
7780
7781 /*
7782 * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
7783 * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
7784 * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
7785 *
7786 * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
7787 * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
7788 * happening.
7789 */
7791 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7793
7794 /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
7796 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7798
7799 /*
7800 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7801 *
7802 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7803 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7804 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7805 */
7808
7809 if (log_checkpoints)
7810 LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
7811
7812 /* Update the process title */
7813 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
7814
7815 CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
7816
7817 /*
7818 * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
7819 * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
7820 */
7821 INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point", NULL);
7822
7823 /*
7824 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7825 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7826 */
7828
7829 /*
7830 * Update pg_control, using current time. Check that it still shows an
7831 * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
7832 * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
7833 * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
7834 */
7836 if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
7837 {
7838 /*
7839 * Update the checkpoint information. We do this even if the cluster
7840 * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
7841 * segments recycled below.
7842 */
7843 ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7844 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
7845
7846 /*
7847 * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
7848 * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY. Normally,
7849 * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
7850 * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied. We do
7851 * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
7852 * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
7853 * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
7854 * included, at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of
7855 * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
7856 * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
7857 * checkpoint record.
7858 */
7860 {
7861 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
7862 {
7863 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7865
7866 /* update local copy */
7869 }
7870 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7872 }
7874 }
7876
7877 /*
7878 * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
7879 * prior checkpoint exists.
7880 */
7883
7884 /*
7885 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
7886 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7887 */
7889
7890 /*
7891 * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
7892 * whichever is later.
7893 */
7895 replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
7896 endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
7897 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7898
7899 INJECTION_POINT("restartpoint-before-slot-invalidation", NULL);
7900
7904 {
7905 /*
7906 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7907 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7908 */
7910 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7911 }
7912 _logSegNo--;
7913
7914 /*
7915 * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
7916 * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
7917 * at end of recovery. If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
7918 * currently replaying.
7919 *
7920 * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
7921 * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
7922 * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
7923 * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
7924 * with that.
7925 */
7926 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7927 replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7928
7929 RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
7930
7931 /*
7932 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7933 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7934 */
7935 PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
7936
7937 /*
7938 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7939 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7940 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7941 * in subtrans.c). When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
7942 * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7943 */
7944 if (EnableHotStandby)
7946
7947 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7948 LogCheckpointEnd(true, flags);
7949
7950 /* Reset the process title */
7951 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
7952
7955 errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%08X",
7956 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
7957 xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
7959
7960 /*
7961 * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
7962 */
7965 "archive_cleanup_command",
7966 false,
7968
7969 return true;
7970}
7971
7972/*
7973 * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
7974 * (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
7975 *
7976 * Returns one of the following enum values:
7977 *
7978 * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
7979 * max_wal_size.
7980 *
7981 * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
7982 * segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
7983 * than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
7984 *
7985 * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
7986 * remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
7987 * above.
7988 *
7989 * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
7990 * a slot with this LSN cannot continue. (Any associated walsender
7991 * processes should have been terminated already.)
7992 *
7993 * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
7994 */
7997{
7998 XLogRecPtr currpos; /* current write LSN */
7999 XLogSegNo currSeg; /* segid of currpos */
8000 XLogSegNo targetSeg; /* segid of targetLSN */
8001 XLogSegNo oldestSeg; /* actual oldest segid */
8002 XLogSegNo oldestSegMaxWalSize; /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
8003 XLogSegNo oldestSlotSeg; /* oldest segid kept by slot */
8005
8006 /*
8007 * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
8008 */
8010 return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
8011
8012 /*
8013 * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
8014 * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size. Initialize
8015 * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
8016 */
8017 currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
8019 KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
8020
8021 /*
8022 * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
8023 * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
8024 * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
8025 */
8027
8028 /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
8031
8032 if (currSeg > keepSegs)
8034 else
8036
8037 /* the segment we care about */
8039
8040 /*
8041 * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
8042 * targetSeg is known to be lost.
8043 */
8044 if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
8045 {
8046 /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
8048 return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
8049
8050 /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
8051 return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
8052 }
8053
8054 /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
8055 if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
8056 return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
8057
8058 /* Definitely lost */
8059 return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
8060}
8061
8062
8063/*
8064 * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
8065 * either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
8066 *
8067 * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
8068 * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
8069 * requirement of replication slots. For the latter criterion we do consider
8070 * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
8071 * from recptr.
8072 *
8073 * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value
8074 * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected
8075 * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again.
8076 * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that
8077 * invalidation is optionally done here, instead.
8078 */
8079static void
8081{
8083 XLogSegNo segno;
8085
8087 segno = currSegNo;
8088
8089 /* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots. */
8092 {
8094
8095 /*
8096 * Account for max_slot_wal_keep_size to avoid keeping more than
8097 * configured. However, don't do that during a binary upgrade: if
8098 * slots were to be invalidated because of this, it would not be
8099 * possible to preserve logical ones during the upgrade.
8100 */
8102 {
8104
8107
8108 if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
8109 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
8110 }
8111 }
8112
8113 /*
8114 * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
8115 * summarized.
8116 */
8119 {
8121
8123 if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
8124 segno = unsummarized_segno;
8125 }
8126
8127 /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
8128 if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
8129 {
8131
8133 if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
8134 {
8135 /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
8136 if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
8137 segno = 1;
8138 else
8139 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
8140 }
8141 }
8142
8143 /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
8144 if (segno < *logSegNo)
8145 *logSegNo = segno;
8146}
8147
8148/*
8149 * Write a NEXTOID log record
8150 */
8151void
8153{
8155 XLogRegisterData(&nextOid, sizeof(Oid));
8157
8158 /*
8159 * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
8160 * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
8161 * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
8162 * record. Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
8163 * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
8164 * does.
8165 *
8166 * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
8167 * database. When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
8168 * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
8169 * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does. The impact
8170 * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
8171 * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
8172 * with the leftover file or directory. But since for safety's sake we
8173 * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
8174 * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
8175 */
8176}
8177
8178/*
8179 * Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
8180 *
8181 * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
8182 * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
8183 *
8184 * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
8185 * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
8186 * write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
8187 */
8190{
8192
8193 /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
8195
8196 if (mark_unimportant)
8199
8200 return RecPtr;
8201}
8202
8203/*
8204 * Write a RESTORE POINT record
8205 */
8208{
8211
8213 strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
8214
8217
8219
8220 ereport(LOG,
8221 errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%08X",
8223
8224 return RecPtr;
8225}
8226
8227/*
8228 * Write an empty XLOG record to assign a distinct LSN.
8229 *
8230 * This is used by some index AMs when building indexes on permanent relations
8231 * with wal_level=minimal. In that scenario, WAL-logging will start after
8232 * commit, but the index AM needs distinct LSNs to detect concurrent page
8233 * modifications. When the current WAL insert position hasn't advanced since
8234 * the last call, we emit a dummy record to ensure we get a new, distinct LSN.
8235 */
8238{
8239 int dummy = 0;
8240
8241 /*
8242 * Records other than XLOG_SWITCH must have content. We use an integer 0
8243 * to satisfy this restriction.
8244 */
8247 XLogRegisterData(&dummy, sizeof(dummy));
8249}
8250
8251/*
8252 * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
8253 * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
8254 */
8255static void
8257{
8266 {
8267 /*
8268 * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
8269 * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
8270 * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
8271 * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
8272 * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
8273 */
8275 {
8278
8280 xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
8281 xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
8282 xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
8283 xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
8284 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
8285 xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
8286 xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
8287
8289 XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
8290
8293 }
8294
8296
8306
8308 }
8309}
8310
8311/*
8312 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
8313 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
8314 *
8315 * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
8316 * concurrently that could update it.
8317 */
8318void
8320{
8322 bool recoveryInProgress;
8323
8324 /*
8325 * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
8326 *
8327 * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
8328 * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
8329 * can update it.
8330 */
8331 if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
8332 return;
8333
8334 /*
8335 * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
8336 * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
8337 * assertion failure.
8338 */
8340
8342
8343 /*
8344 * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
8345 * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
8346 * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
8347 * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
8348 * flag.
8349 */
8350 if (fullPageWrites)
8351 {
8353 Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
8355 }
8356
8357 /*
8358 * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
8359 * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
8360 */
8362 {
8364 XLogRegisterData(&fullPageWrites, sizeof(bool));
8365
8367 }
8368
8369 if (!fullPageWrites)
8370 {
8372 Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
8374 }
8376}
8377
8378/*
8379 * XLOG resource manager's routines
8380 *
8381 * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
8382 * not all record types are related to control file updates.
8383 *
8384 * NOTE: Some XLOG record types that are directly related to WAL recovery
8385 * are handled in xlogrecovery_redo().
8386 */
8387void
8389{
8390 uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
8391 XLogRecPtr lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
8392
8393 /*
8394 * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
8395 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
8396 */
8397 Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
8398 !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
8399
8400 if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
8401 {
8402 Oid nextOid;
8403
8404 /*
8405 * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
8406 * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
8407 * around. Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
8408 * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly. We still take
8409 * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
8410 */
8411 memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
8413 TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
8416 }
8417 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
8418 {
8419 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8420 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8421
8422 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8423 /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
8425 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8428 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
8432 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8433
8435 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8436
8437 /*
8438 * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
8439 * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
8440 */
8441 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8442
8443 /*
8444 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
8445 * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
8446 * never arrive.
8447 */
8451 ereport(PANIC,
8452 (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
8453
8454 /*
8455 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
8456 * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
8457 * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
8458 * for prepared transactions.
8459 */
8461 {
8462 TransactionId *xids;
8463 int nxids;
8465 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
8467
8469
8470 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
8472
8473 /*
8474 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
8475 * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
8476 * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
8477 * with their parent prepared transactions.
8478 */
8479 running.xcnt = nxids;
8480 running.subxcnt = 0;
8482 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8484 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8485 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
8486 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
8487 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
8488 running.xids = xids;
8489
8491 }
8492
8493 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8497
8498 /*
8499 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8500 * record.
8501 */
8502 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8503 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8504 ereport(PANIC,
8505 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
8506 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8507
8508 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8509
8510 /*
8511 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8512 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8513 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8514 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8515 */
8517 }
8518 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
8519 {
8520 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8521 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8522
8523 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8524 /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
8527 checkPoint.nextXid))
8528 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8530
8531 /*
8532 * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
8533 * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records. The nextOid
8534 * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
8535 * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records. We could try to take the
8536 * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
8537 * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
8538 * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do. In any case,
8539 * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
8540 * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
8541 */
8542
8543 /* Handle multixact */
8545 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8546
8547 /*
8548 * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
8549 * generated by an older primary.
8550 */
8552 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8554 checkPoint.oldestXid))
8556 checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8557 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8561
8562 /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
8563 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8564 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8565 ereport(PANIC,
8566 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
8567 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8568
8569 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8570
8571 /*
8572 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8573 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8574 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8575 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8576 */
8578 }
8579 else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
8580 {
8581 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8582 }
8583 else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
8584 {
8586 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8587
8588 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
8589
8590 /*
8591 * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
8592 * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
8593 * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
8594 */
8595
8596 /*
8597 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8598 * record.
8599 */
8600 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8601 if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8602 ereport(PANIC,
8603 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
8604 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8605 }
8606 else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
8607 {
8608 /* nothing to do here */
8609 }
8610 else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
8611 {
8612 /* nothing to do here */
8613 }
8614 else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
8615 {
8616 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
8617 }
8618 else if (info == XLOG_ASSIGN_LSN)
8619 {
8620 /* nothing to do here, see XLogGetFakeLSN() */
8621 }
8622 else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
8623 {
8624 /*
8625 * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
8626 * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
8627 * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
8628 * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
8629 *
8630 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
8631 * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
8632 * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
8633 * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
8634 * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
8635 *
8636 * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
8637 * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
8638 * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
8639 */
8640 for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
8641 {
8642 Buffer buffer;
8643
8644 if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
8645 {
8646 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
8647 elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
8648 continue;
8649 }
8650
8651 if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
8652 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
8653 UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
8654 }
8655 }
8656 else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
8657 {
8658 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8659 }
8660 else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
8661 {
8663
8664 /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
8665 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
8666
8668 ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
8669 ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
8670 ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
8671 ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
8672 ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
8673 ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
8674 ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
8675
8676 /*
8677 * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
8678 * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
8679 * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
8680 * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
8681 * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
8682 * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
8683 */
8685 {
8688 }
8690 {
8691 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8692
8693 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8695 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
8696 }
8697
8698 CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
8700 ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
8701
8704
8705 /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
8707 }
8708 else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
8709 {
8710 bool fpw;
8711
8712 memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
8713
8714 /*
8715 * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
8716 * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
8717 * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
8718 */
8719 if (!fpw)
8720 {
8725 }
8726
8727 /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
8729 }
8730 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
8731 {
8732 /* nothing to do here, just for informational purposes */
8733 }
8734 else if (info == XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE)
8735 {
8736 bool status;
8737
8738 memcpy(&status, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
8739
8740 /*
8741 * We need to toggle the logical decoding status and update the
8742 * XLogLogicalInfo cache of processes synchronously because
8743 * XLogLogicalInfoActive() is used even during read-only queries
8744 * (e.g., via RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding()). In the
8745 * 'disable' case, it is safe to invalidate existing slots after
8746 * disabling logical decoding because logical decoding cannot process
8747 * subsequent WAL records, which may not contain logical information.
8748 */
8749 if (status)
8751 else
8753
8754 elog(DEBUG1, "update logical decoding status to %d during recovery",
8755 status);
8756
8757 if (InRecovery && InHotStandby)
8758 {
8759 if (!status)
8760 {
8761 /*
8762 * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the
8763 * primary disabled logical decoding.
8764 */
8766 0, InvalidOid,
8768 }
8769 else if (sync_replication_slots)
8770 {
8771 /*
8772 * Signal the postmaster to launch the slotsync worker.
8773 *
8774 * XXX: For simplicity, we keep the slotsync worker running
8775 * even after logical decoding is disabled. A future
8776 * improvement can consider starting and stopping the worker
8777 * based on logical decoding status change.
8778 */
8780 }
8781 }
8782 }
8783}
8784
8785/*
8786 * Return the extra open flags used for opening a file, depending on the
8787 * value of the GUCs wal_sync_method, fsync and debug_io_direct.
8788 */
8789static int
8790get_sync_bit(int method)
8791{
8792 int o_direct_flag = 0;
8793
8794 /*
8795 * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process. The WAL
8796 * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
8797 * after it's written. Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
8798 * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
8799 */
8802
8803 /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
8804 if (!enableFsync)
8805 return o_direct_flag;
8806
8807 switch (method)
8808 {
8809 /*
8810 * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
8811 * not supported on the current platform. But if not, they are
8812 * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
8813 * be seen here.
8814 */
8818 return o_direct_flag;
8819#ifdef O_SYNC
8821 return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
8822#endif
8823#ifdef O_DSYNC
8825 return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
8826#endif
8827 default:
8828 /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
8829 elog(ERROR, "unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", method);
8830 return 0; /* silence warning */
8831 }
8832}
8833
8834/*
8835 * GUC support
8836 */
8837void
8839{
8841 {
8842 /*
8843 * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
8844 * currently open log segment (if any). Also, if the open flag is
8845 * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
8846 * bit) at next use.
8847 */
8848 if (openLogFile >= 0)
8849 {
8851 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
8852 {
8853 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8854 int save_errno;
8855
8856 save_errno = errno;
8859 errno = save_errno;
8860 ereport(PANIC,
8862 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
8863 }
8864
8867 XLogFileClose();
8868 }
8869 }
8870}
8871
8872
8873/*
8874 * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
8875 *
8876 * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
8877 * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
8878 */
8879void
8881{
8882 char *msg = NULL;
8884
8885 Assert(tli != 0);
8886
8887 /*
8888 * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
8889 * file.
8890 */
8891 if (!enableFsync ||
8894 return;
8895
8896 /*
8897 * Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file for pg_stat_io.
8898 */
8900
8902 switch (wal_sync_method)
8903 {
8905 if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8906 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
8907 break;
8908#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
8910 if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8911 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
8912 break;
8913#endif
8915 if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
8916 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
8917 break;
8920 /* not reachable */
8921 Assert(false);
8922 break;
8923 default:
8924 ereport(PANIC,
8926 errmsg_internal("unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", wal_sync_method));
8927 break;
8928 }
8929
8930 /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
8931 if (msg)
8932 {
8933 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8934 int save_errno = errno;
8935
8937 errno = save_errno;
8938 ereport(PANIC,
8940 errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
8941 }
8942
8944
8946 start, 1, 0);
8947}
8948
8949/*
8950 * do_pg_backup_start is the workhorse of the user-visible pg_backup_start()
8951 * function. It creates the necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the
8952 * backup state and tablespace map.
8953 *
8954 * Input parameters are "state" (the backup state), "fast" (if true, we do
8955 * the checkpoint in fast mode), and "tablespaces" (if non-NULL, indicates a
8956 * list of tablespaceinfo structs describing the cluster's tablespaces.).
8957 *
8958 * The tablespace map contents are appended to passed-in parameter
8959 * tablespace_map and the caller is responsible for including it in the backup
8960 * archive as 'tablespace_map'. The tablespace_map file is required mainly for
8961 * tar format in windows as native windows utilities are not able to create
8962 * symlinks while extracting files from tar. However for consistency and
8963 * platform-independence, we do it the same way everywhere.
8964 *
8965 * It fills in "state" with the information required for the backup, such
8966 * as the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
8967 * backup (starttli) and the corresponding timeline ID (starttli).
8968 *
8969 * Every successfully started backup must be stopped by calling
8970 * do_pg_backup_stop() or do_pg_abort_backup(). There can be many
8971 * backups active at the same time.
8972 *
8973 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
8974 * permissions of the calling user!
8975 */
8976void
8977do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces,
8979{
8981
8982 Assert(state != NULL);
8984
8985 /*
8986 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
8987 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
8988 */
8990 ereport(ERROR,
8992 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
8993 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
8994
8996 ereport(ERROR,
8998 errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
8999 MAXPGPATH)));
9000
9001 strlcpy(state->name, backupidstr, sizeof(state->name));
9002
9003 /*
9004 * Mark backup active in shared memory. We must do full-page WAL writes
9005 * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
9006 * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
9007 * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
9008 * our write to the same page. This can be fixed as long as the first
9009 * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
9010 * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
9011 * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
9012 * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record. (Once the
9013 * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
9014 * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
9015 * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
9016 *
9017 * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
9018 * backup from the standby.
9019 *
9020 * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
9021 * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
9022 * XLogInsertRecord().
9023 */
9027
9028 /*
9029 * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
9030 * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
9031 * after this block is over.
9032 */
9034 {
9035 bool gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
9036 DIR *tblspcdir;
9037 struct dirent *de;
9039 int datadirpathlen;
9040
9041 /*
9042 * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
9043 * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
9044 * old timeline IDs. That would otherwise happen if you called
9045 * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
9046 * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
9047 * the beginning with the old timeline ID. That can cause trouble at
9048 * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
9049 * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
9050 * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
9051 *
9052 * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
9053 * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
9054 * recovery case described above.
9055 */
9057 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9058
9059 do
9060 {
9061 bool checkpointfpw;
9062
9063 /*
9064 * Force a CHECKPOINT. Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
9065 * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
9066 * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
9067 * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
9068 *
9069 * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
9070 * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
9071 * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
9072 * positions.
9073 *
9074 * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
9075 * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
9076 * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
9077 *
9078 * We use CHECKPOINT_FAST only if requested by user (via passing
9079 * fast = true). Otherwise this can take awhile.
9080 */
9082 (fast ? CHECKPOINT_FAST : 0));
9083
9084 /*
9085 * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
9086 * its REDO pointer. The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
9087 * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
9088 * pointer.
9089 */
9091 state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
9092 state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
9096
9098 {
9100
9101 /*
9102 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
9103 * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
9104 * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
9105 */
9109
9110 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
9111 ereport(ERROR,
9113 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9114 "since last restartpoint"),
9115 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9116 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9117 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9118 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9119
9120 /*
9121 * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
9122 * record and don't write the backup history file, the
9123 * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
9124 * that two base backups started at the same time might use
9125 * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
9126 */
9127 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9128 }
9129
9130 /*
9131 * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
9132 * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
9133 * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
9134 * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
9135 * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
9136 * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
9137 * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
9138 * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
9139 * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
9140 */
9142 if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
9143 {
9144 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
9145 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9146 }
9148 } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
9149
9150 /*
9151 * Construct tablespace_map file.
9152 */
9154
9155 /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
9157 while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, PG_TBLSPC_DIR)) != NULL)
9158 {
9159 char fullpath[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(PG_TBLSPC_DIR)];
9160 char linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
9161 char *relpath = NULL;
9162 char *s;
9164 char *badp;
9165 Oid tsoid;
9166
9167 /*
9168 * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
9169 *
9170 * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
9171 * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
9172 * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
9173 * criteria, skip it.
9174 */
9175 if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
9176 continue;
9177 errno = 0;
9178 tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
9179 if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
9180 continue;
9181
9182 snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "%s/%s", PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9183
9184 de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
9185
9186 if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
9187 {
9189 int rllen;
9190
9191 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
9192 if (rllen < 0)
9193 {
9195 (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
9196 fullpath)));
9197 continue;
9198 }
9199 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
9200 {
9202 (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
9203 fullpath)));
9204 continue;
9205 }
9206 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
9207
9208 /*
9209 * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
9210 * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
9211 * elsewhere.
9212 */
9213 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
9217
9218 /*
9219 * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
9220 * tablespace map file.
9221 */
9223 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
9224 {
9225 if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
9228 }
9230 de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
9231 pfree(escapedpath.data);
9232 }
9233 else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
9234 {
9235 /*
9236 * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
9237 * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
9238 * only.
9239 *
9240 * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
9241 * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
9242 */
9243 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "%s/%s",
9244 PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9246 }
9247 else
9248 {
9249 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
9250 continue;
9251 }
9252
9254 ti->oid = tsoid;
9255 ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
9256 ti->rpath = relpath;
9257 ti->size = -1;
9258
9259 if (tablespaces)
9260 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
9261 }
9263
9264 state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9265 }
9267
9268 state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
9269
9270 /*
9271 * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
9272 */
9274}
9275
9276/*
9277 * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
9278 */
9281{
9282 return sessionBackupState;
9283}
9284
9285/*
9286 * do_pg_backup_stop
9287 *
9288 * Utility function called at the end of an online backup. It creates history
9289 * file (if required), resets sessionBackupState and so on. It can optionally
9290 * wait for WAL segments to be archived.
9291 *
9292 * "state" is filled with the information necessary to restore from this
9293 * backup with its stop LSN (stoppoint), its timeline ID (stoptli), etc.
9294 *
9295 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
9296 * permissions of the calling user!
9297 */
9298void
9300{
9301 bool backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
9302 char histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
9306 FILE *fp;
9308 int waits = 0;
9309 bool reported_waiting = false;
9310
9311 Assert(state != NULL);
9312
9314
9315 /*
9316 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
9317 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
9318 */
9320 ereport(ERROR,
9322 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
9323 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
9324
9325 /*
9326 * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
9327 *
9328 * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
9329 * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
9330 * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
9331 */
9333
9334 /*
9335 * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
9336 * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
9337 */
9340
9341 /*
9342 * Clean up session-level lock.
9343 *
9344 * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
9345 * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
9346 * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
9347 * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
9348 * cleaned up before it.
9349 */
9351
9353
9354 /*
9355 * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
9356 * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
9357 */
9358 if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
9359 ereport(ERROR,
9361 errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
9362 errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
9363 "and should not be used. "
9364 "Try taking another online backup.")));
9365
9366 /*
9367 * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
9368 * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
9369 * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
9370 * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
9371 * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
9372 * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
9373 * however.
9374 *
9375 * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
9376 * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
9377 * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
9378 * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
9379 * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
9380 * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
9381 * available.
9382 *
9383 * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
9384 * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
9385 * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
9386 * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
9387 *
9388 * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
9389 * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
9390 * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
9391 * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
9392 * backup history file during recovery.
9393 */
9395 {
9397
9398 /*
9399 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
9400 * full-page writes.
9401 */
9405
9406 if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
9407 ereport(ERROR,
9409 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9410 "during online backup"),
9411 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9412 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9413 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9414 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9415
9416
9418 state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
9421 }
9422 else
9423 {
9424 char *history_file;
9425
9426 /*
9427 * Write the backup-end xlog record
9428 */
9430 XLogRegisterData(&state->startpoint,
9431 sizeof(state->startpoint));
9433
9434 /*
9435 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
9436 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
9437 */
9438 state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
9439
9440 /*
9441 * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
9442 * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
9443 */
9444 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9445
9446 state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9447
9448 /*
9449 * Write the backup history file
9450 */
9453 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9454 fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
9455 if (!fp)
9456 ereport(ERROR,
9458 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
9459 histfilepath)));
9460
9461 /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
9463 fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
9465
9466 if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
9467 ereport(ERROR,
9469 errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
9470 histfilepath)));
9471
9472 /*
9473 * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files. As a side effect,
9474 * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
9475 * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
9476 * immediately.
9477 */
9479 }
9480
9481 /*
9482 * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
9483 * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
9484 * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
9485 * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
9486 * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
9487 * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
9488 * the required WAL.
9489 *
9490 * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
9491 * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
9492 * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
9493 * archived as well.
9494 *
9495 * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
9496 * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
9497 * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
9498 * or you can set statement_timeout. Also, some notices are issued to
9499 * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
9500 */
9501
9502 if (waitforarchive &&
9505 {
9509
9512 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9513
9515 waits = 0;
9516
9519 {
9521
9522 if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
9523 {
9525 (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
9526 reported_waiting = true;
9527 }
9528
9531 1000L,
9534
9536 {
9537 seconds_before_warning *= 2; /* This wraps in >10 years... */
9539 (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
9540 waits),
9541 errhint("Check that your \"archive_command\" is executing properly. "
9542 "You can safely cancel this backup, "
9543 "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
9544 }
9545 }
9546
9548 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
9549 }
9550 else if (waitforarchive)
9552 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
9553}
9554
9555
9556/*
9557 * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
9558 *
9559 * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_backup_stop(), by taking the
9560 * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
9561 * an error handler.
9562 *
9563 * 'arg' indicates that it's being called during backup setup; so
9564 * sessionBackupState has not been modified yet, but runningBackups has
9565 * already been incremented. When it's false, then it's invoked as a
9566 * before_shmem_exit handler, and therefore we must not change state
9567 * unless sessionBackupState indicates that a backup is actually running.
9568 *
9569 * NB: This gets used as a PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP callback and
9570 * before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking signature.
9571 */
9572void
9574{
9576
9577 /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
9579
9581 {
9585
9588
9591 errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
9592 }
9593}
9594
9595/*
9596 * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
9597 * session, unless this has already been done.
9598 */
9599void
9601{
9602 static bool already_done = false;
9603
9604 if (already_done)
9605 return;
9607 already_done = true;
9608}
9609
9610/*
9611 * Get latest WAL insert pointer
9612 */
9615{
9618
9619 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9620 current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
9621 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9622
9624}
9625
9626/*
9627 * Get latest WAL record end pointer
9628 */
9631{
9634
9635 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9636 current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
9637 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9638
9640}
9641
9642/*
9643 * Get latest WAL write pointer
9644 */
9652
9653/*
9654 * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
9655 * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
9656 */
9657void
9665
9666/* Thin wrapper around ShutdownWalRcv(). */
9667void
9675
9676/* Enable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
9677void
9684
9685/* Disable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
9686void
9693
9694bool
9696{
9697 bool result;
9698
9702
9703 return result;
9704}
9705
9706/*
9707 * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
9708 */
9709void
Datum idx(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition _int_op.c:262
static void pg_atomic_write_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:485
#define pg_memory_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:141
#define pg_read_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:154
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:476
#define pg_write_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:155
static uint64 pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 target)
Definition atomics.h:595
static uint64 pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, int64 add_)
Definition atomics.h:532
static void pg_atomic_init_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:453
static void pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:504
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:467
TimeLineID findNewestTimeLine(TimeLineID startTLI)
Definition timeline.c:265
void restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(TimeLineID begin, TimeLineID end)
Definition timeline.c:51
void writeTimeLineHistory(TimeLineID newTLI, TimeLineID parentTLI, XLogRecPtr switchpoint, char *reason)
Definition timeline.c:305
void startup_progress_timeout_handler(void)
Definition startup.c:302
long TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time)
Definition timestamp.c:1748
bool TimestampDifferenceExceeds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time, int msec)
Definition timestamp.c:1772
TimestampTz GetCurrentTimestamp(void)
Definition timestamp.c:1636
const char * timestamptz_to_str(TimestampTz t)
Definition timestamp.c:1853
Datum now(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition timestamp.c:1600
static bool backup_started_in_recovery
Definition basebackup.c:129
int Buffer
Definition buf.h:23
void CheckPointBuffers(int flags)
Definition bufmgr.c:4343
void UnlockReleaseBuffer(Buffer buffer)
Definition bufmgr.c:5522
#define Min(x, y)
Definition c.h:1093
#define pg_attribute_unused()
Definition c.h:140
#define likely(x)
Definition c.h:431
#define MAXALIGN(LEN)
Definition c.h:898
#define TYPEALIGN(ALIGNVAL, LEN)
Definition c.h:891
uint8_t uint8
Definition c.h:616
#define Max(x, y)
Definition c.h:1087
#define Assert(condition)
Definition c.h:945
#define PG_BINARY
Definition c.h:1376
#define pg_attribute_always_inline
Definition c.h:299
uint64_t uint64
Definition c.h:619
#define unlikely(x)
Definition c.h:432
uint32_t uint32
Definition c.h:618
#define MAXALIGN64(LEN)
Definition c.h:923
#define PG_UINT64_MAX
Definition c.h:679
#define MemSet(start, val, len)
Definition c.h:1109
uint32 TransactionId
Definition c.h:738
size_t Size
Definition c.h:691
#define CATALOG_VERSION_NO
Definition catversion.h:60
void WakeupCheckpointer(void)
void AbsorbSyncRequests(void)
double CheckPointCompletionTarget
void RequestCheckpoint(int flags)
void BootStrapCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:834
void StartupCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:845
void CheckPointCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:905
void TrimCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:860
void StartupCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:610
void CommitTsParameterChange(bool newvalue, bool oldvalue)
Definition commit_ts.c:642
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition commit_ts.c:109
void CompleteCommitTsInitialization(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:620
void BootStrapCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:596
void SetCommitTsLimit(TransactionId oldestXact, TransactionId newestXact)
Definition commit_ts.c:889
void CheckPointCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:796
void update_controlfile(const char *DataDir, ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool do_sync)
#define fprintf(file, fmt, msg)
Definition cubescan.l:21
int64 TimestampTz
Definition timestamp.h:39
Datum arg
Definition elog.c:1322
int errcode_for_file_access(void)
Definition elog.c:897
int errcode(int sqlerrcode)
Definition elog.c:874
#define _(x)
Definition elog.c:95
#define LOG
Definition elog.h:31
int errhint(const char *fmt,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
int errdetail(const char *fmt,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
#define FATAL
Definition elog.h:41
int int errmsg_internal(const char *fmt,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
#define WARNING
Definition elog.h:36
int int int errmsg_plural(const char *fmt_singular, const char *fmt_plural, unsigned long n,...) pg_attribute_printf(1
#define DEBUG2
Definition elog.h:29
#define PANIC
Definition elog.h:42
#define DEBUG1
Definition elog.h:30
#define ERROR
Definition elog.h:39
#define elog(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:226
#define NOTICE
Definition elog.h:35
#define ereport(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:150
int MakePGDirectory(const char *directoryName)
Definition fd.c:3963
int FreeDir(DIR *dir)
Definition fd.c:3009
int pg_fsync_no_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:442
int io_direct_flags
Definition fd.c:172
int durable_rename(const char *oldfile, const char *newfile, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:783
int pg_fdatasync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:481
int CloseTransientFile(int fd)
Definition fd.c:2855
int BasicOpenFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:1090
int FreeFile(FILE *file)
Definition fd.c:2827
int pg_fsync_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:462
void ReleaseExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1225
int data_sync_elevel(int elevel)
Definition fd.c:3986
static void Insert(File file)
Definition fd.c:1301
DIR * AllocateDir(const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2891
int durable_unlink(const char *fname, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:873
void ReserveExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1207
struct dirent * ReadDir(DIR *dir, const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2957
int pg_fsync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:390
FILE * AllocateFile(const char *name, const char *mode)
Definition fd.c:2628
int OpenTransientFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:2678
void SyncDataDirectory(void)
Definition fd.c:3594
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL
Definition fd.h:55
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT
Definition fd.h:56
#define PG_O_DIRECT
Definition fd.h:123
#define palloc_object(type)
Definition fe_memutils.h:74
ssize_t pg_pwrite_zeros(int fd, size_t size, pgoff_t offset)
Definition file_utils.c:709
PGFileType get_dirent_type(const char *path, const struct dirent *de, bool look_through_symlinks, int elevel)
Definition file_utils.c:547
PGFileType
Definition file_utils.h:19
@ PGFILETYPE_LNK
Definition file_utils.h:24
@ PGFILETYPE_DIR
Definition file_utils.h:23
@ PGFILETYPE_REG
Definition file_utils.h:22
bool IsBinaryUpgrade
Definition globals.c:121
int NBuffers
Definition globals.c:142
pid_t PostmasterPid
Definition globals.c:106
bool enableFsync
Definition globals.c:129
ProcNumber MyProcNumber
Definition globals.c:90
bool IsUnderPostmaster
Definition globals.c:120
int MaxConnections
Definition globals.c:143
volatile uint32 CritSectionCount
Definition globals.c:45
char * DataDir
Definition globals.c:71
bool IsPostmasterEnvironment
Definition globals.c:119
struct Latch * MyLatch
Definition globals.c:63
int max_worker_processes
Definition globals.c:144
int set_config_option_ext(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source, Oid srole, GucAction action, bool changeVal, int elevel, bool is_reload)
Definition guc.c:3288
void SetConfigOption(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source)
Definition guc.c:4228
void * guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size)
Definition guc.c:637
#define newval
struct config_generic * find_option(const char *name, bool create_placeholders, bool skip_errors, int elevel)
Definition guc.c:1114
@ GUC_ACTION_SET
Definition guc.h:203
#define GUC_check_errdetail
Definition guc.h:507
GucSource
Definition guc.h:112
@ PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT
Definition guc.h:114
@ PGC_S_OVERRIDE
Definition guc.h:123
@ PGC_INTERNAL
Definition guc.h:73
@ PGC_POSTMASTER
Definition guc.h:74
return str start
#define TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE
Definition heaptoast.h:84
#define bufsize
#define INJECTION_POINT(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_CACHED(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_LOAD(name)
WalUsage pgWalUsage
Definition instrument.c:22
#define close(a)
Definition win32.h:12
#define write(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:14
#define read(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:13
void before_shmem_exit(pg_on_exit_callback function, Datum arg)
Definition ipc.c:344
#define PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:47
#define PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:52
int i
Definition isn.c:77
#define LOBLKSIZE
void SetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:290
void ResetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:374
int WaitLatch(Latch *latch, int wakeEvents, long timeout, uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition latch.c:172
List * lappend(List *list, void *datum)
Definition list.c:339
void list_free(List *list)
Definition list.c:1546
int max_locks_per_xact
Definition lock.c:53
void UpdateLogicalDecodingStatusEndOfRecovery(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:554
bool IsLogicalDecodingEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:205
bool IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:221
void StartupLogicalDecodingStatus(bool last_status)
Definition logicalctl.c:147
void DisableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:492
void EnableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:341
void LWLockUpdateVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1729
void LWLockReleaseClearVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1867
bool LWLockAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1177
bool LWLockWaitForVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 oldval, uint64 *newval)
Definition lwlock.c:1593
void LWLockRelease(LWLock *lock)
Definition lwlock.c:1794
void LWLockInitialize(LWLock *lock, int tranche_id)
Definition lwlock.c:699
bool LWLockConditionalAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1348
bool LWLockAcquireOrWait(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1405
@ LW_SHARED
Definition lwlock.h:113
@ LW_EXCLUSIVE
Definition lwlock.h:112
char * pstrdup(const char *in)
Definition mcxt.c:1781
void pfree(void *pointer)
Definition mcxt.c:1616
MemoryContext TopMemoryContext
Definition mcxt.c:166
void * palloc(Size size)
Definition mcxt.c:1387
void MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(MemoryContext context, bool allow)
Definition mcxt.c:743
#define AllocSetContextCreate
Definition memutils.h:129
#define ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES
Definition memutils.h:160
#define AmStartupProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:390
#define IsBootstrapProcessingMode()
Definition miscadmin.h:477
#define START_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:150
#define CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS()
Definition miscadmin.h:123
@ B_CHECKPOINTER
Definition miscadmin.h:363
#define END_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:152
#define AmWalReceiverProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:391
bool process_shared_preload_libraries_done
Definition miscinit.c:1788
BackendType MyBackendType
Definition miscinit.c:65
void MultiXactSetNextMXact(MultiXactId nextMulti, MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:2055
void MultiXactAdvanceOldest(MultiXactId oldestMulti, Oid oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:2258
void MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(bool is_shutdown, MultiXactId *nextMulti, MultiXactOffset *nextMultiOffset, MultiXactId *oldestMulti, Oid *oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:2009
void CheckPointMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:2031
void TrimMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1896
void MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(MultiXactId minMulti, MultiXactOffset minMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:2231
void BootStrapMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1855
void StartupMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1871
void SetMultiXactIdLimit(MultiXactId oldest_datminmxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition multixact.c:2077
#define FirstMultiXactId
Definition multixact.h:26
static char * errmsg
void StartupReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:731
void CheckPointReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:605
static MemoryContext MemoryContextSwitchTo(MemoryContext context)
Definition palloc.h:124
#define ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED
#define INDEX_MAX_KEYS
#define NAMEDATALEN
#define MAXPGPATH
#define DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE
#define SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT
#define PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE
#define PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE
#define FLOATFORMAT_VALUE
Definition pg_control.h:203
#define XLOG_RESTORE_POINT
Definition pg_control.h:76
#define XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:77
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
Definition pg_control.h:83
#define PG_CONTROL_VERSION
Definition pg_control.h:25
#define XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
Definition pg_control.h:82
#define XLOG_ASSIGN_LSN
Definition pg_control.h:81
#define XLOG_FPI
Definition pg_control.h:80
#define XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT
Definition pg_control.h:79
#define MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN
Definition pg_control.h:28
#define XLOG_NEXTOID
Definition pg_control.h:72
@ DB_IN_PRODUCTION
Definition pg_control.h:99
@ DB_SHUTDOWNING
Definition pg_control.h:96
@ DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:98
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:95
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED
Definition pg_control.h:94
@ DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:97
#define XLOG_NOOP
Definition pg_control.h:71
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN
Definition pg_control.h:69
#define PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE
Definition pg_control.h:260
#define XLOG_SWITCH
Definition pg_control.h:73
#define XLOG_BACKUP_END
Definition pg_control.h:74
#define XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:75
#define XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:84
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
Definition pg_control.h:70
#define XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:78
uint32 pg_crc32c
Definition pg_crc32c.h:38
#define COMP_CRC32C(crc, data, len)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:153
#define EQ_CRC32C(c1, c2)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:42
#define INIT_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:41
#define FIN_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:158
const void size_t len
return crc
static char * filename
Definition pg_dumpall.c:133
#define lfirst(lc)
Definition pg_list.h:172
static rewind_source * source
Definition pg_rewind.c:89
static char buf[DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE]
bool pgstat_report_fixed
Definition pgstat.c:218
void pgstat_restore_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:507
void pgstat_discard_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:519
@ IOOBJECT_WAL
Definition pgstat.h:282
@ IOCONTEXT_INIT
Definition pgstat.h:291
@ IOCONTEXT_NORMAL
Definition pgstat.h:292
@ IOOP_FSYNC
Definition pgstat.h:311
@ IOOP_WRITE
Definition pgstat.h:319
PgStat_CheckpointerStats PendingCheckpointerStats
instr_time pgstat_prepare_io_time(bool track_io_guc)
Definition pgstat_io.c:91
void pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOObject io_object, IOContext io_context, IOOp io_op, instr_time start_time, uint32 cnt, uint64 bytes)
Definition pgstat_io.c:122
int64 pg_time_t
Definition pgtime.h:23
size_t pg_strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, const struct pg_tm *t)
Definition strftime.c:128
struct pg_tm * pg_localtime(const pg_time_t *timep, const pg_tz *tz)
Definition localtime.c:1345
PGDLLIMPORT pg_tz * log_timezone
Definition pgtz.c:31
bool pg_strong_random(void *buf, size_t len)
int pg_strcasecmp(const char *s1, const char *s2)
#define pg_pwrite
Definition port.h:248
#define snprintf
Definition port.h:260
#define IS_DIR_SEP(ch)
Definition port.h:103
size_t strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t siz)
Definition strlcpy.c:45
static bool DatumGetBool(Datum X)
Definition postgres.h:100
static Datum BoolGetDatum(bool X)
Definition postgres.h:112
uint64_t Datum
Definition postgres.h:70
#define InvalidOid
unsigned int Oid
void CheckPointPredicate(void)
Definition predicate.c:1052
static int fd(const char *x, int i)
static int fb(int x)
short access
#define GetPGProcByNumber(n)
Definition proc.h:501
#define DELAY_CHKPT_START
Definition proc.h:136
#define DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE
Definition proc.h:137
bool MinimumActiveBackends(int min)
Definition procarray.c:3576
TransactionId GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning(void)
Definition procarray.c:1981
bool HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(VirtualTransactionId *vxids, int nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3049
void ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(RunningTransactions running)
Definition procarray.c:1053
TransactionId GetOldestActiveTransactionId(bool inCommitOnly, bool allDbs)
Definition procarray.c:2832
void ProcArrayInitRecovery(TransactionId initializedUptoXID)
Definition procarray.c:1022
VirtualTransactionId * GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(int *nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3004
#define INVALID_PROC_NUMBER
Definition procnumber.h:26
int ProcNumber
Definition procnumber.h:24
static void set_ps_display(const char *activity)
Definition ps_status.h:40
void ResetUnloggedRelations(int op)
Definition reinit.c:47
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT
Definition reinit.h:28
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP
Definition reinit.h:27
void RelationCacheInitFileRemove(void)
Definition relcache.c:6915
void CheckPointRelationMap(void)
Definition relmapper.c:612
#define relpath(rlocator, forknum)
Definition relpath.h:150
#define PG_TBLSPC_DIR
Definition relpath.h:41
void StartupReorderBuffer(void)
ResourceOwner CurrentResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:173
ResourceOwner AuxProcessResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:176
void CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(void)
#define RM_MAX_ID
Definition rmgr.h:33
Size add_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition shmem.c:485
Size mul_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition shmem.c:500
void * ShmemInitStruct(const char *name, Size size, bool *foundPtr)
Definition shmem.c:381
void pg_usleep(long microsec)
Definition signal.c:53
void CheckPointReplicationSlots(bool is_shutdown)
Definition slot.c:2310
void StartupReplicationSlots(void)
Definition slot.c:2388
bool InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(uint32 possible_causes, XLogSegNo oldestSegno, Oid dboid, TransactionId snapshotConflictHorizon)
Definition slot.c:2206
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED
Definition slot.h:62
@ RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT
Definition slot.h:68
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL
Definition slot.h:66
bool sync_replication_slots
Definition slotsync.c:122
void smgrdestroyall(void)
Definition smgr.c:386
void CheckPointSnapBuild(void)
Definition snapbuild.c:1973
void DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles(void)
Definition snapmgr.c:1587
static void SpinLockRelease(volatile slock_t *lock)
Definition spin.h:62
static void SpinLockAcquire(volatile slock_t *lock)
Definition spin.h:56
static void SpinLockInit(volatile slock_t *lock)
Definition spin.h:50
void reset(void)
PGPROC * MyProc
Definition proc.c:68
PROC_HDR * ProcGlobal
Definition proc.c:71
XLogRecPtr LogStandbySnapshot(void)
Definition standby.c:1283
void InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:96
void ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:162
@ SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS
Definition standby.h:120
void appendStringInfo(StringInfo str, const char *fmt,...)
Definition stringinfo.c:145
void appendBinaryStringInfo(StringInfo str, const void *data, int datalen)
Definition stringinfo.c:281
void appendStringInfoString(StringInfo str, const char *s)
Definition stringinfo.c:230
void appendStringInfoChar(StringInfo str, char ch)
Definition stringinfo.c:242
void initStringInfo(StringInfo str)
Definition stringinfo.c:97
Oid oldestMultiDB
Definition pg_control.h:52
MultiXactId oldestMulti
Definition pg_control.h:51
MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset
Definition pg_control.h:48
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:56
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition pg_control.h:49
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:40
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:39
TransactionId oldestActiveXid
Definition pg_control.h:65
bool fullPageWrites
Definition pg_control.h:42
MultiXactId nextMulti
Definition pg_control.h:47
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition pg_control.h:45
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:54
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:53
int wal_level
Definition pg_control.h:43
bool logicalDecodingEnabled
Definition pg_control.h:44
XLogRecPtr redo
Definition pg_control.h:37
Oid oldestXidDB
Definition pg_control.h:50
uint64 ckpt_agg_sync_time
Definition xlog.h:187
uint64 ckpt_longest_sync
Definition xlog.h:186
TimestampTz ckpt_start_t
Definition xlog.h:172
TimestampTz ckpt_end_t
Definition xlog.h:176
int ckpt_segs_removed
Definition xlog.h:182
TimestampTz ckpt_write_t
Definition xlog.h:173
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_end_t
Definition xlog.h:175
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_t
Definition xlog.h:174
int ckpt_bufs_written
Definition xlog.h:178
int ckpt_segs_recycled
Definition xlog.h:183
int ckpt_slru_written
Definition xlog.h:179
char mock_authentication_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN]
Definition pg_control.h:239
uint32 pg_control_version
Definition pg_control.h:127
uint32 xlog_seg_size
Definition pg_control.h:215
XLogRecPtr backupStartPoint
Definition pg_control.h:172
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition pg_control.h:187
CheckPoint checkPointCopy
Definition pg_control.h:137
uint32 slru_pages_per_segment
Definition pg_control.h:212
XLogRecPtr backupEndPoint
Definition pg_control.h:173
XLogRecPtr minRecoveryPoint
Definition pg_control.h:170
uint32 data_checksum_version
Definition pg_control.h:226
XLogRecPtr unloggedLSN
Definition pg_control.h:139
uint32 indexMaxKeys
Definition pg_control.h:218
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:134
bool default_char_signedness
Definition pg_control.h:232
XLogRecPtr checkPoint
Definition pg_control.h:135
uint64 system_identifier
Definition pg_control.h:112
uint32 catalog_version_no
Definition pg_control.h:128
TimeLineID minRecoveryPointTLI
Definition pg_control.h:171
pg_crc32c crc
Definition pg_control.h:242
uint32 toast_max_chunk_size
Definition pg_control.h:220
Definition dirent.c:26
Definition pg_list.h:54
char data[XLOG_BLCKSZ]
Definition c.h:1233
ProcNumber walwriterProc
Definition proc.h:485
PgStat_Counter sync_time
Definition pgstat.h:268
PgStat_Counter write_time
Definition pgstat.h:267
void(* rm_mask)(char *pagedata, BlockNumber blkno)
TransactionId oldestRunningXid
Definition standby.h:130
TransactionId nextXid
Definition standby.h:129
TransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition standby.h:133
subxids_array_status subxid_status
Definition standby.h:128
TransactionId * xids
Definition standby.h:135
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:232
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:233
FullTransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition transam.h:238
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition transam.h:220
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition transam.h:222
pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt
Definition xlog.c:374
XLogRecPtr lastImportantAt
Definition xlog.c:375
LWLock lock
Definition xlog.c:373
pg_atomic_uint64 minWaitedLSN[WAIT_LSN_TYPE_COUNT]
Definition xlogwait.h:85
int64 wal_buffers_full
Definition instrument.h:57
uint64 wal_bytes
Definition instrument.h:55
int64 wal_fpi
Definition instrument.h:54
uint64 wal_fpi_bytes
Definition instrument.h:56
int64 wal_records
Definition instrument.h:53
CheckPoint lastCheckPoint
Definition xlog.c:548
XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst
Definition xlog.c:459
slock_t info_lck
Definition xlog.c:556
XLogRecPtr InitializedUpTo
Definition xlog.c:488
char * pages
Definition xlog.c:495
pg_time_t lastSegSwitchTime
Definition xlog.c:470
XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN
Definition xlog.c:462
RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState
Definition xlog.c:519
TimeLineID InsertTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:512
XLogRecPtr lastSegSwitchLSN
Definition xlog.c:471
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo
Definition xlog.c:464
pg_atomic_uint64 * xlblocks
Definition xlog.c:496
pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult
Definition xlog.c:475
int XLogCacheBlck
Definition xlog.c:497
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:460
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:546
XLogRecPtr lastFpwDisableRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:554
XLogCtlInsert Insert
Definition xlog.c:456
bool InstallXLogFileSegmentActive
Definition xlog.c:529
bool WalWriterSleeping
Definition xlog.c:536
XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN
Definition xlog.c:461
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr
Definition xlog.c:547
pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult
Definition xlog.c:476
pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult
Definition xlog.c:474
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:513
pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN
Definition xlog.c:467
WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:448
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:434
uint64 PrevBytePos
Definition xlog.c:412
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:421
int runningBackups
Definition xlog.c:442
slock_t insertpos_lck
Definition xlog.c:402
uint64 CurrBytePos
Definition xlog.c:411
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:435
XLogRecPtr lastBackupStart
Definition xlog.c:443
XLogRecPtr xlp_pageaddr
XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:206
XLogRecPtr ReadRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:205
XLogRecPtr xl_prev
Definition xlogrecord.h:45
pg_crc32c xl_crc
Definition xlogrecord.h:49
uint8 xl_info
Definition xlogrecord.h:46
uint32 xl_tot_len
Definition xlogrecord.h:43
TransactionId xl_xid
Definition xlogrecord.h:44
RmgrId xl_rmid
Definition xlogrecord.h:47
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:332
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:331
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:326
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:325
Definition guc.h:174
TimestampTz rp_time
void StartupSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestActiveXID)
Definition subtrans.c:285
void CheckPointSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:331
void BootStrapSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:271
void TruncateSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestXact)
Definition subtrans.c:387
void ProcessSyncRequests(void)
Definition sync.c:287
void SyncPreCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:178
void SyncPostCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:203
TimeoutId RegisterTimeout(TimeoutId id, timeout_handler_proc handler)
Definition timeout.c:505
@ STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT
Definition timeout.h:38
#define TransactionIdRetreat(dest)
Definition transam.h:141
#define InvalidTransactionId
Definition transam.h:31
static void FullTransactionIdRetreat(FullTransactionId *dest)
Definition transam.h:103
#define XidFromFullTransactionId(x)
Definition transam.h:48
#define FirstGenbkiObjectId
Definition transam.h:195
#define FirstNormalTransactionId
Definition transam.h:34
#define TransactionIdIsValid(xid)
Definition transam.h:41
static FullTransactionId FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(uint32 epoch, TransactionId xid)
Definition transam.h:71
#define TransactionIdIsNormal(xid)
Definition transam.h:42
#define FullTransactionIdPrecedes(a, b)
Definition transam.h:51
static bool TransactionIdPrecedes(TransactionId id1, TransactionId id2)
Definition transam.h:263
void RecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2086
void restoreTwoPhaseData(void)
Definition twophase.c:1907
int max_prepared_xacts
Definition twophase.c:117
TransactionId PrescanPreparedTransactions(TransactionId **xids_p, int *nxids_p)
Definition twophase.c:1969
void StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2048
void CheckPointTwoPhase(XLogRecPtr redo_horizon)
Definition twophase.c:1825
WALInsertLock l
Definition xlog.c:387
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:388
bool SplitIdentifierString(char *rawstring, char separator, List **namelist)
Definition varlena.c:2777
void SetTransactionIdLimit(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition varsup.c:376
void AdvanceOldestClogXid(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid)
Definition varsup.c:359
TransamVariablesData * TransamVariables
Definition varsup.c:34
static void pgstat_report_wait_start(uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition wait_event.h:69
static void pgstat_report_wait_end(void)
Definition wait_event.h:85
#define WL_TIMEOUT
#define WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH
#define WL_LATCH_SET
static TimestampTz wakeup[NUM_WALRCV_WAKEUPS]
XLogRecPtr Flush
XLogRecPtr Write
XLogRecPtr GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(XLogRecPtr *latestChunkStart, TimeLineID *receiveTLI)
void ShutdownWalRcv(void)
void WalSndWakeup(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.c:3822
int max_wal_senders
Definition walsender.c:130
void WalSndInitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:3901
void WalSndWaitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:3927
static void WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.h:65
#define WalSndWakeupRequest()
Definition walsender.h:58
bool summarize_wal
void WaitForWalSummarization(XLogRecPtr lsn)
void WakeupWalSummarizer(void)
XLogRecPtr GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(TimeLineID *tli, bool *lsn_is_exact)
int WalWriterFlushAfter
Definition walwriter.c:72
int WalWriterDelay
Definition walwriter.c:71
#define stat
Definition win32_port.h:74
#define EINTR
Definition win32_port.h:361
#define S_ISDIR(m)
Definition win32_port.h:315
#define kill(pid, sig)
Definition win32_port.h:490
#define SIGUSR1
Definition win32_port.h:170
#define readlink(path, buf, size)
Definition win32_port.h:226
#define O_CLOEXEC
Definition win32_port.h:344
#define O_DSYNC
Definition win32_port.h:346
int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tp, void *tzp)
void MarkSubxactTopXidLogged(void)
Definition xact.c:593
void MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny(void)
Definition xact.c:543
int XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
Definition xlog.c:3401
void assign_wal_sync_method(int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:8838
static const char * CheckpointFlagsString(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:6760
static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
Definition xlog.c:7500
uint64 GetSystemIdentifier(void)
Definition xlog.c:4611
int wal_decode_buffer_size
Definition xlog.c:140
XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:257
static XLogCtlData * XLogCtl
Definition xlog.c:569
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:126
void UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
Definition xlog.c:8319
bool RecoveryInProgress(void)
Definition xlog.c:6444
static void CleanupBackupHistory(void)
Definition xlog.c:4182
void GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
Definition xlog.c:6577
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
Definition xlog.c:6630
XLogRecPtr RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
Definition xlog.c:8189
void do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:9573
XLogSegNo XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
Definition xlog.c:3779
XLogRecPtr XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn, uint8 flags, int num_fpi, uint64 fpi_bytes, bool topxid_included)
Definition xlog.c:750
char * XLogArchiveCommand
Definition xlog.c:124
int wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:120
Size WALReadFromBuffers(char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1755
static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
Definition xlog.c:1511
static void WALInsertLockRelease(void)
Definition xlog.c:1452
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1865
bool EnableHotStandby
Definition xlog.c:125
static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
Definition xlog.c:1478
XLogRecPtr GetRedoRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6547
void assign_wal_consistency_checking(const char *newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:4815
static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:4225
void SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9678
static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
Definition xlog.c:1992
static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
Definition xlog.c:1423
static void UpdateControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4602
void StartupXLOG(void)
Definition xlog.c:5501
bool IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9695
static int openLogFile
Definition xlog.c:638
void BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:5110
XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd
Definition xlog.c:258
bool CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7715
static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
Definition xlog.c:4120
int CommitDelay
Definition xlog.c:136
static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3886
static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:7565
XLogRecPtr GetInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6592
bool wal_init_zero
Definition xlog.c:131
static void CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
Definition xlog.c:2158
XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
Definition xlog.c:2666
int XLogArchiveMode
Definition xlog.c:123
SessionBackupState get_backup_status(void)
Definition xlog.c:9280
static void XLogReportParameters(void)
Definition xlog.c:8256
#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target)
Definition xlog.c:623
void CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3748
int wal_level
Definition xlog.c:135
static void LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
Definition xlog.c:6781
static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:277
void assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2194
static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3584
static void WriteControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4260
int wal_segment_size
Definition xlog.c:147
WALAvailability GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
Definition xlog.c:7996
const char * show_archive_command(void)
Definition xlog.c:4868
#define UsableBytesInPage
Definition xlog.c:600
int max_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:118
void XLOGShmemInit(void)
Definition xlog.c:4995
void ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:6712
bool DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
Definition xlog.c:4631
static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
Definition xlog.c:6394
RecoveryState GetRecoveryState(void)
Definition xlog.c:6480
int XLogArchiveTimeout
Definition xlog.c:122
static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5361
#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)
Definition xlog.c:606
bool wal_recycle
Definition xlog.c:132
static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:4030
pg_time_t GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
Definition xlog.c:6695
const char * show_effective_wal_level(void)
Definition xlog.c:4895
static int XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
Definition xlog.c:4677
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1905
static void LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint, int flags)
Definition xlog.c:6799
static int get_sync_bit(int method)
Definition xlog.c:8790
static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult
Definition xlog.c:615
void XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
Definition xlog.c:2653
void SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6319
static bool lastFullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:221
char * wal_consistency_checking_string
Definition xlog.c:129
static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
Definition xlog.c:1378
int CommitSiblings
Definition xlog.c:137
static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1232
bool GetDefaultCharSignedness(void)
Definition xlog.c:4645
static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate
Definition xlog.c:163
static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
Definition xlog.c:1948
const char * show_in_hot_standby(void)
Definition xlog.c:4880
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:9614
Size XLOGShmemSize(void)
Definition xlog.c:4945
void SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
Definition xlog.c:9710
bool wal_log_hints
Definition xlog.c:127
static void XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5286
static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
Definition xlog.c:5457
#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)
Definition xlog.c:594
int wal_sync_method
Definition xlog.c:134
int XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3639
int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:139
XLogRecPtr GetFlushRecPtr(TimeLineID *insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6609
static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3711
static bool doPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:290
static bool holdingAllLocks
Definition xlog.c:655
static TimeLineID openLogTLI
Definition xlog.c:640
XLogRecPtr XactLastCommitEnd
Definition xlog.c:259
WalLevel GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby(void)
Definition xlog.c:4936
bool log_checkpoints
Definition xlog.c:133
static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
Definition xlog.c:8080
static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
Definition xlog.c:2291
void InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(void)
Definition xlog.c:4842
static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
Definition xlog.c:2687
static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6532
void assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2187
void RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3961
XLogRecPtr GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6666
void xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:8388
static int MyLockNo
Definition xlog.c:654
static void RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:7675
bool XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:3129
void register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
Definition xlog.c:9600
static double PrevCheckPointDistance
Definition xlog.c:164
void ReachedEndOfBackup(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:6357
void LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:4923
static void XLogFileClose(void)
Definition xlog.c:3660
int wal_compression
Definition xlog.c:128
static void UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
Definition xlog.c:6906
static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress
Definition xlog.c:228
XLogSegNo XLogGetOldestSegno(TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3795
XLogRecPtr GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:9646
void ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9687
static WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:572
static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo
Definition xlog.c:639
#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)
Definition xlog.c:583
int wal_retrieve_retry_interval
Definition xlog.c:138
int XLOGbuffers
Definition xlog.c:121
bool XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
Definition xlog.c:2972
const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[]
Definition xlog.c:195
void GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
Definition xlog.c:9658
char * GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
Definition xlog.c:4621
bool track_wal_io_timing
Definition xlog.c:141
static XLogSegNo XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
Definition xlog.c:2217
static int UsableBytesInSegment
Definition xlog.c:609
static char * GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1639
WalInsertClass
Definition xlog.c:563
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH
Definition xlog.c:565
@ WALINSERT_NORMAL
Definition xlog.c:564
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
Definition xlog.c:566
bool XLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6499
void do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces, BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
Definition xlog.c:8977
static ControlFileData * ControlFile
Definition xlog.c:577
bool check_wal_segment_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:2201
static void XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno, int upto)
Definition xlog.c:3439
static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed
Definition xlog.c:240
static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
Definition xlog.c:3853
XLogRecPtr XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
Definition xlog.c:8207
static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:649
#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS
Definition xlog.c:154
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet(void)
Definition xlog.c:6646
void do_pg_backup_stop(BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
Definition xlog.c:9299
bool check_wal_consistency_checking(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:4728
const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[]
Definition xlog.c:175
int min_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:119
bool CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7009
#define BootstrapTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:115
CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats
Definition xlog.c:213
bool check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:4693
XLogRecPtr GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
Definition xlog.c:4660
static char * str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
Definition xlog.c:5273
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertEndRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:9630
void XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
Definition xlog.c:8152
void XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:2767
static void ReadControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4370
static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState
Definition xlog.c:395
XLogRecPtr XLogAssignLSN(void)
Definition xlog.c:8237
static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7635
static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:651
int CheckPointSegments
Definition xlog.c:160
static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred
Definition xlog.c:170
static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1115
void XLogShutdownWalRcv(void)
Definition xlog.c:9668
#define NextBufIdx(idx)
Definition xlog.c:587
static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
Definition xlog.c:3833
static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI
Definition xlog.c:650
void issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:8880
static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1171
void XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
Definition xlog.c:2596
bool XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
Definition xlog.c:2267
bool * wal_consistency_checking
Definition xlog.c:130
static int XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli, bool *added, char *path)
Definition xlog.c:3213
static void update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:6944
#define XLogArchivingActive()
Definition xlog.h:101
#define TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD
Definition xlog.h:325
#define XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT
Definition xlog.h:166
#define TABLESPACE_MAP
Definition xlog.h:324
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS
Definition xlog.h:68
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF
Definition xlog.h:66
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ON
Definition xlog.h:67
#define CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED
Definition xlog.h:154
#define XLogLogicalInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:136
#define STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:320
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG
Definition xlog.h:159
WALAvailability
Definition xlog.h:199
@ WALAVAIL_REMOVED
Definition xlog.h:205
@ WALAVAIL_RESERVED
Definition xlog.h:201
@ WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED
Definition xlog.h:204
@ WALAVAIL_EXTENDED
Definition xlog.h:202
@ WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN
Definition xlog.h:200
#define BACKUP_LABEL_OLD
Definition xlog.h:322
#define CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition xlog.h:151
@ WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE
Definition xlog.h:83
#define BACKUP_LABEL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:321
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME
Definition xlog.h:160
#define CHECKPOINT_FORCE
Definition xlog.h:153
SessionBackupState
Definition xlog.h:305
@ SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING
Definition xlog.h:307
@ SESSION_BACKUP_NONE
Definition xlog.h:306
#define CHECKPOINT_WAIT
Definition xlog.h:156
#define CHECKPOINT_FAST
Definition xlog.h:152
#define RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:319
#define CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN
Definition xlog.h:150
#define XLogArchivingAlways()
Definition xlog.h:104
WalLevel
Definition xlog.h:74
@ WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA
Definition xlog.h:76
@ WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL
Definition xlog.h:77
@ WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL
Definition xlog.h:75
RecoveryState
Definition xlog.h:91
@ RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH
Definition xlog.h:92
@ RECOVERY_STATE_DONE
Definition xlog.h:94
@ RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE
Definition xlog.h:93
#define XLogIsNeeded()
Definition xlog.h:111
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN
Definition xlog.h:27
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC
Definition xlog.h:26
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
Definition xlog.h:28
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC
Definition xlog.h:29
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC
Definition xlog.h:25
#define XLogStandbyInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:125
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD
static RmgrData GetRmgr(RmgrId rmid)
#define IsValidWalSegSize(size)
XLogLongPageHeaderData * XLogLongPageHeader
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
#define XLOG_CONTROL_FILE
#define XLogSegmentOffset(xlogptr, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsXLogFileName(const char *fname)
static void XLogFromFileName(const char *fname, TimeLineID *tli, XLogSegNo *logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLByteToPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(segno, offset, wal_segsz_bytes, dest)
#define MAXFNAMELEN
XLogPageHeaderData * XLogPageHeader
#define XLOGDIR
#define XLP_LONG_HEADER
static bool IsBackupHistoryFileName(const char *fname)
#define XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC
#define XLByteToSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void XLogFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XRecOffIsValid(xlrp)
#define SizeOfXLogShortPHD
#define SizeOfXLogLongPHD
static void XLogFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool RmgrIdExists(RmgrId rmid)
#define XLByteInPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsPartialXLogFileName(const char *fname)
bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsBusy(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotifySeg(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
void ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, uint32 wait_event_info)
bool XLogArchiveCheckDone(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotify(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog)
char * build_backup_content(BackupState *state, bool ishistoryfile)
Definition xlogbackup.c:29
#define XLogRecPtrIsValid(r)
Definition xlogdefs.h:29
#define LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn)
Definition xlogdefs.h:47
#define FirstNormalUnloggedLSN
Definition xlogdefs.h:37
uint64 XLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:21
#define InvalidXLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:28
uint32 TimeLineID
Definition xlogdefs.h:63
#define DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD
Definition xlogdefs.h:83
uint64 XLogSegNo
Definition xlogdefs.h:52
XLogRecPtr XLogInsert(RmgrId rmid, uint8 info)
Definition xloginsert.c:479
void XLogRegisterData(const void *data, uint32 len)
Definition xloginsert.c:369
void XLogSetRecordFlags(uint8 flags)
Definition xloginsert.c:461
void XLogBeginInsert(void)
Definition xloginsert.c:153
XLogReaderState * XLogReaderAllocate(int wal_segment_size, const char *waldir, XLogReaderRoutine *routine, void *private_data)
Definition xlogreader.c:108
bool DecodeXLogRecord(XLogReaderState *state, DecodedXLogRecord *decoded, XLogRecord *record, XLogRecPtr lsn, char **errormsg)
size_t DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(size_t xl_tot_len)
#define XLogRecGetInfo(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:409
#define XLogRecGetData(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:414
#define XL_ROUTINE(...)
Definition xlogreader.h:117
#define XLogRecMaxBlockId(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:417
#define XLogRecHasBlockImage(decoder, block_id)
Definition xlogreader.h:422
#define XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:416
#define SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort
Definition xlogrecord.h:217
#define XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT
Definition xlogrecord.h:241
#define SizeOfXLogRecord
Definition xlogrecord.h:55
void ShutdownWalRecovery(void)
bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested
bool InArchiveRecovery
void RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(const char *param_name, int currValue, int minValue)
void PerformWalRecovery(void)
char * archiveCleanupCommand
XLogRecPtr GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayEndTLI)
void xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record)
bool PromoteIsTriggered(void)
static XLogRecPtr missingContrecPtr
XLogRecPtr GetXLogReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayTLI)
static XLogRecPtr abortedRecPtr
EndOfWalRecoveryInfo * FinishWalRecovery(void)
void InitWalRecovery(ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool *wasShutdown_ptr, bool *haveBackupLabel_ptr, bool *haveTblspcMap_ptr)
char * recoveryEndCommand
TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLI
TimestampTz GetLatestXTime(void)
bool XLogHaveInvalidPages(void)
Definition xlogutils.c:224
XLogRedoAction XLogReadBufferForRedo(XLogReaderState *record, uint8 block_id, Buffer *buf)
Definition xlogutils.c:303
HotStandbyState standbyState
Definition xlogutils.c:53
bool InRecovery
Definition xlogutils.c:50
@ STANDBY_DISABLED
Definition xlogutils.h:52
@ STANDBY_INITIALIZED
Definition xlogutils.h:53
#define InHotStandby
Definition xlogutils.h:60
@ BLK_RESTORED
Definition xlogutils.h:76
struct WaitLSNState * waitLSNState
Definition xlogwait.c:69
void WaitLSNWakeup(WaitLSNType lsnType, XLogRecPtr currentLSN)
Definition xlogwait.c:318
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:44
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_REPLAY
Definition xlogwait.h:39
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:41
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_WRITE
Definition xlogwait.h:40